2002-04-12 Don Howard <dhoward@redhat.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @set EDITION Ninth
32
33 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
34 @set DATE December 2001
35
36 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
37
38 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
39 @c manuals to an info tree.
40 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
41 @direntry
42 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
43 @end direntry
44
45 @ifinfo
46 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
49 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
50 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
53 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
54 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
55
56 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
60 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
61 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
62
63 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
64 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
65 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
66 development.''
67 @end ifinfo
68
69 @titlepage
70 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
71 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
72 @sp 1
73 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
74 @subtitle @value{DATE}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
88 @sp 2
89 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
90 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
92 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
93
94 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
97 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
100
101 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104 development.''
105 @end titlepage
106 @page
107
108 @ifnottex
109 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
111 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
115 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
116 @value{GDBVN}.
117
118 Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
119
120 @menu
121 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128 * Stack:: Examining the stack
129 * Source:: Examining source files
130 * Data:: Examining data
131 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
132 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
133
134 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
135
136 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
137 * Altering:: Altering execution
138 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
139 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
140 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
141 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
142 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
143 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
144 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
145 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
147 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
148
149 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
155 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
156 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
157 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
158 how you can copy and share GDB
159 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
160 * Index:: Index
161 @end menu
162
163 @end ifnottex
164
165 @contents
166
167 @node Summary
168 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
169
170 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
171 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
172 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
173
174 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
175 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
176
177 @itemize @bullet
178 @item
179 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
180
181 @item
182 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
183
184 @item
185 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
186
187 @item
188 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
189 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
190 @end itemize
191
192 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
193 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
194 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
195
196 @cindex Chill
197 @cindex Modula-2
198 Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
199 see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
200
201 @cindex Pascal
202 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
203 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
204 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
205 syntax.
206
207 @cindex Fortran
208 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
209 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
210 underscore.
211
212 @menu
213 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
214 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
215 @end menu
216
217 @node Free Software
218 @unnumberedsec Free software
219
220 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
221 General Public License
222 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
223 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
224 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
225 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
226 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
227 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
228
229 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
230 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
231 from anyone else.
232
233 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
234
235 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
236 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
237 include with the free software. Many of our most important
238 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
239 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
240 when an important free software package does not come with a free
241 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
242 gaps today.
243
244 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
245 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
246 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
247 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
248 them from the free software world.
249
250 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
251 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
252 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
253 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
254 contract to make it non-free.
255
256 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
257 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
258 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
259 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
260 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
261 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
262 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
263
264 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
265 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
266 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
267 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
268
269 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
270 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
271 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
272 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
273 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
274 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
275 community.
276
277 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
278 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
279 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
280 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
281 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
282 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
283 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
284 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
285 of the manual.
286
287 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
288 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
289 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
290 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
291 manual to replace it.
292
293 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
294 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
295 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
296 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
297 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
298 the free software community.
299
300 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
301 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
302 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
303 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
304 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
305 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
306 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
307 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
308 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
309
310 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
311 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
312 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
313 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
314 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
315 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
316 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
317 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
318
319 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
320 published by other publishers, at
321 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
322
323 @node Contributors
324 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
325
326 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
327 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
328 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
329 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
330 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
331 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
332 blow-by-blow account.
333
334 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
335
336 @quotation
337 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
338 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
339 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
340 @end quotation
341
342 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
343 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
344 releases:
345 Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
346 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
347 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
348 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
349 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
350 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
351 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
352 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
353 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
354
355 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
356 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
357
358 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
359 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
360 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
361 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
362 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
363
364 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
365 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
366 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
367
368 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
369 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
370
371 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
372
373 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
374 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
375 support.
376 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
377 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
378 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
379 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
380 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
381 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
382 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
383 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
384 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
385 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
386 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
387 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
388 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
389 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
390 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
391
392 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
393
394 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
395 libraries.
396
397 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
398 about several machine instruction sets.
399
400 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
401 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
402 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
403 and RDI targets, respectively.
404
405 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
406 command-line editing and command history.
407
408 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
409 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
410
411 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
412 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
413 symbols.
414
415 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
416 Super-H processors.
417
418 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
419
420 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
421
422 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
423
424 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
425
426 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
427
428 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
429 watchpoints.
430
431 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
432
433 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
434
435 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
436 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
437
438 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
439 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
440 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
441 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
442 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
443 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
444 information in this manual.
445
446 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
447 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
448
449 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
450 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
451 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
452 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
453 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
454 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
455 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
456 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
457 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
458 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
459 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
460 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
461 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
462 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
463 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
464
465
466 @node Sample Session
467 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
468
469 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
470 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
471 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
472
473 @iftex
474 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
475 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
476 @end iftex
477
478 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
479 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
480
481 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
482 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
483 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
484 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
485 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
486 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
487 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
488 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
489 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
490
491 @smallexample
492 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
493 $ @b{./m4}
494 @b{define(foo,0000)}
495
496 @b{foo}
497 0000
498 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
499
500 @b{bar}
501 0000
502 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
503
504 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
505 @b{baz}
506 @b{C-d}
507 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
508 @end smallexample
509
510 @noindent
511 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
512
513 @smallexample
514 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
515 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
516 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
517 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
518 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
519 the conditions.
520 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
521 for details.
522
523 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
524 (@value{GDBP})
525 @end smallexample
526
527 @noindent
528 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
529 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
530 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
531 that examples fit in this manual.
532
533 @smallexample
534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
535 @end smallexample
536
537 @noindent
538 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
539 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
540 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
541 @code{break} command.
542
543 @smallexample
544 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
545 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
546 @end smallexample
547
548 @noindent
549 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
550 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
551 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
552
553 @smallexample
554 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
555 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
556 @b{define(foo,0000)}
557
558 @b{foo}
559 0000
560 @end smallexample
561
562 @noindent
563 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
564 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
565 context where it stops.
566
567 @smallexample
568 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
569
570 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
571 at builtin.c:879
572 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
573 @end smallexample
574
575 @noindent
576 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
577 the next line of the current function.
578
579 @smallexample
580 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
581 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
582 : nil,
583 @end smallexample
584
585 @noindent
586 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
587 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
588 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
589 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
590
591 @smallexample
592 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
593 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
594 at input.c:530
595 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
600 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
601 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
602 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
603 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
604 stack frame for each active subroutine.
605
606 @smallexample
607 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
608 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
609 at input.c:530
610 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
611 at builtin.c:882
612 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
613 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
614 at macro.c:71
615 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
616 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
617 @end smallexample
618
619 @noindent
620 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
621 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
622 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
623
624 @smallexample
625 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
626 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
627 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
628 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
629 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
632 : xstrdup(rq);
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
634 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
635 @end smallexample
636
637 @noindent
638 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
639 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
640 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
641 (@code{print}) to see their values.
642
643 @smallexample
644 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
645 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
647 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
652 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
653 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
654
655 @smallexample
656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
657 533 xfree(rquote);
658 534
659 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
660 : xstrdup (lq);
661 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
662 : xstrdup (rq);
663 537
664 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
665 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
666 540 @}
667 541
668 542 void
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
673 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
674
675 @smallexample
676 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
677 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
678 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
679 540 @}
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
681 $3 = 9
682 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
683 $4 = 7
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
688 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
689 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
690 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
691 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
692 assignments.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
696 $5 = 7
697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
698 $6 = 9
699 @end smallexample
700
701 @noindent
702 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
703 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
704 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
705 example that caused trouble initially:
706
707 @smallexample
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
709 Continuing.
710
711 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
712
713 baz
714 0000
715 @end smallexample
716
717 @noindent
718 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
719 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
720 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
721
722 @smallexample
723 @b{C-d}
724 Program exited normally.
725 @end smallexample
726
727 @noindent
728 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
729 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
730 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
731
732 @smallexample
733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
734 @end smallexample
735
736 @node Invocation
737 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
738
739 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
740 The essentials are:
741 @itemize @bullet
742 @item
743 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
744 @item
745 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
746 @end itemize
747
748 @menu
749 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
750 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
751 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
752 @end menu
753
754 @node Invoking GDB
755 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
756
757 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
758 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
759
760 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
761 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
762
763 The command-line options described here are designed
764 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
765 options may effectively be unavailable.
766
767 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
768 specifying an executable program:
769
770 @smallexample
771 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
776 specified:
777
778 @smallexample
779 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
780 @end smallexample
781
782 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
783 to debug a running process:
784
785 @smallexample
786 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
791 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
792
793 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
794 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
795 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
796 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
797 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
798
799 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
800 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
801 option processing.
802 @smallexample
803 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
804 @end smallexample
805 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
806 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
807
808 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
809 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
810
811 @smallexample
812 @value{GDBP} -silent
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
817 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
818
819 @noindent
820 Type
821
822 @smallexample
823 @value{GDBP} -help
824 @end smallexample
825
826 @noindent
827 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
828 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
829
830 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
831 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
832 @samp{-x} option is used.
833
834
835 @menu
836 * File Options:: Choosing files
837 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
838 @end menu
839
840 @node File Options
841 @subsection Choosing files
842
843 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
844 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
845 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
846 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
847 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
848 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
849 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
850 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
851 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
852 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
853 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
854 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
855 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
856
857 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
858 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
859 argument and ignore it.
860
861 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
862 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
863 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
864 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
865 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
866
867 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
868 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
869 @c it.
870
871 @table @code
872 @item -symbols @var{file}
873 @itemx -s @var{file}
874 @cindex @code{--symbols}
875 @cindex @code{-s}
876 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
877
878 @item -exec @var{file}
879 @itemx -e @var{file}
880 @cindex @code{--exec}
881 @cindex @code{-e}
882 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
883 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
884
885 @item -se @var{file}
886 @cindex @code{--se}
887 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
888 file.
889
890 @item -core @var{file}
891 @itemx -c @var{file}
892 @cindex @code{--core}
893 @cindex @code{-c}
894 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
895
896 @item -c @var{number}
897 @item -pid @var{number}
898 @itemx -p @var{number}
899 @cindex @code{--pid}
900 @cindex @code{-p}
901 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
902 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
903 file named @var{number}.
904
905 @item -command @var{file}
906 @itemx -x @var{file}
907 @cindex @code{--command}
908 @cindex @code{-x}
909 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
910 Files,, Command files}.
911
912 @item -directory @var{directory}
913 @itemx -d @var{directory}
914 @cindex @code{--directory}
915 @cindex @code{-d}
916 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
917
918 @item -m
919 @itemx -mapped
920 @cindex @code{--mapped}
921 @cindex @code{-m}
922 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
923 supported on all systems.}@*
924 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
925 system call, you can use this option
926 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
927 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
928 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
929 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
930 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
931 the symbol table from the executable program.
932
933 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
934 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
935 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
936
937 @item -r
938 @itemx -readnow
939 @cindex @code{--readnow}
940 @cindex @code{-r}
941 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
942 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
943 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
944
945 @end table
946
947 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
948 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
949 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
950 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
951 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
952
953 @smallexample
954 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
955 @end smallexample
956
957 @node Mode Options
958 @subsection Choosing modes
959
960 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
961 batch mode or quiet mode.
962
963 @table @code
964 @item -nx
965 @itemx -n
966 @cindex @code{--nx}
967 @cindex @code{-n}
968 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
969 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
970 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
971 files}.
972
973 @item -quiet
974 @itemx -silent
975 @itemx -q
976 @cindex @code{--quiet}
977 @cindex @code{--silent}
978 @cindex @code{-q}
979 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
980 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
981
982 @item -batch
983 @cindex @code{--batch}
984 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
985 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
986 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
987 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
988 in the command files.
989
990 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
991 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
992 make this more useful, the message
993
994 @smallexample
995 Program exited normally.
996 @end smallexample
997
998 @noindent
999 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1000 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1001 mode.
1002
1003 @item -nowindows
1004 @itemx -nw
1005 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1006 @cindex @code{-nw}
1007 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1008 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1009 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1010
1011 @item -windows
1012 @itemx -w
1013 @cindex @code{--windows}
1014 @cindex @code{-w}
1015 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1016 used if possible.
1017
1018 @item -cd @var{directory}
1019 @cindex @code{--cd}
1020 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1021 instead of the current directory.
1022
1023 @item -fullname
1024 @itemx -f
1025 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1026 @cindex @code{-f}
1027 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1028 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1029 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1030 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1031 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1032 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1033 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1034 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1035 frame.
1036
1037 @item -epoch
1038 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1039 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1040 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1041 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1042 separate window.
1043
1044 @item -annotate @var{level}
1045 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1046 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1047 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1048 (@pxref{Annotations}).
1049 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1050 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1051 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1052 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1053 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1054
1055 @item -async
1056 @cindex @code{--async}
1057 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1058 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1059 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1060 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1061 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1062 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1063 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1064 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1065 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1066 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1067 yet.)
1068 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1069 @c should be removed.
1070
1071 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1072 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1073 @samp{-noasync} option.
1074
1075 @item -noasync
1076 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1077 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1078
1079 @item --args
1080 @cindex @code{--args}
1081 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1082 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1083 This option stops option processing.
1084
1085 @item -baud @var{bps}
1086 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1087 @cindex @code{--baud}
1088 @cindex @code{-b}
1089 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1090 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1091
1092 @item -tty @var{device}
1093 @itemx -t @var{device}
1094 @cindex @code{--tty}
1095 @cindex @code{-t}
1096 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1097 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1098
1099 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1100 @item -tui
1101 @cindex @code{--tui}
1102 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1103 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1104 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1105 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1106 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1107 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1108
1109 @c @item -xdb
1110 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1111 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1112 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1113 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1114 @c systems.
1115
1116 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1117 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1118 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1119 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1120 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1121
1122 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1123 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1124 @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1125 @value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
1126
1127 @item -write
1128 @cindex @code{--write}
1129 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1130 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1131 (@pxref{Patching}).
1132
1133 @item -statistics
1134 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1135 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1136 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1137
1138 @item -version
1139 @cindex @code{--version}
1140 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1141 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1142
1143 @end table
1144
1145 @node Quitting GDB
1146 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1147 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1148 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1149
1150 @table @code
1151 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1152 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1153 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1154 @itemx q
1155 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1156 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1157 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1158 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1159 error code.
1160 @end table
1161
1162 @cindex interrupt
1163 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1164 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1165 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1166 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1167 until a time when it is safe.
1168
1169 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1170 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1171 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1172
1173 @node Shell Commands
1174 @section Shell commands
1175
1176 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1177 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1178 just use the @code{shell} command.
1179
1180 @table @code
1181 @kindex shell
1182 @cindex shell escape
1183 @item shell @var{command string}
1184 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1185 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1186 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1187 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1188 @end table
1189
1190 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1191 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1192 @value{GDBN}:
1193
1194 @table @code
1195 @kindex make
1196 @cindex calling make
1197 @item make @var{make-args}
1198 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1199 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1200 @end table
1201
1202 @node Commands
1203 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1204
1205 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1206 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1207 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1208 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1209 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1210
1211 @menu
1212 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1213 * Completion:: Command completion
1214 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1215 @end menu
1216
1217 @node Command Syntax
1218 @section Command syntax
1219
1220 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1221 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1222 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1223 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1224 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1225 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1226
1227 @cindex abbreviation
1228 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1229 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1230 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1231 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1232 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1233 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1234 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1235
1236 @cindex repeating commands
1237 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1238 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1239 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1240 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1241 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1242 repeat.
1243
1244 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1245 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1246 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1247
1248 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1249 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1250 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1251 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1252 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1253
1254 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1255 @cindex comment
1256 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1257 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1258 Files,,Command files}).
1259
1260 @cindex repeating command sequences
1261 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1262 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1263 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1264 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1265 for editing.
1266
1267 @node Completion
1268 @section Command completion
1269
1270 @cindex completion
1271 @cindex word completion
1272 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1273 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1274 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1275 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1276
1277 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1278 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1279 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1280 enter it). For example, if you type
1281
1282 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1283 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1284 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1285 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1286 @smallexample
1287 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1288 @end smallexample
1289
1290 @noindent
1291 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1292 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1293
1294 @smallexample
1295 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1296 @end smallexample
1297
1298 @noindent
1299 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1300 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1301 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1302 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1303 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1304 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1305
1306 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1307 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1308 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1309 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1310 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1311 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1312 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1313 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1314 example:
1315
1316 @smallexample
1317 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1318 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1319 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1320 make_abs_section make_function_type
1321 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1322 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1323 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1324 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1325 @end smallexample
1326
1327 @noindent
1328 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1329 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1330 command.
1331
1332 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1333 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1334 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1335 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1336 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1337
1338 @cindex quotes in commands
1339 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1340 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1341 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1342 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1343 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1344 @value{GDBN} commands.
1345
1346 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1347 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1348 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1349 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1350 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1351 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1352 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1353 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1354 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1355 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1356 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1357
1358 @smallexample
1359 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1360 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1361 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1362 @end smallexample
1363
1364 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1365 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1366 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1367 place:
1368
1369 @smallexample
1370 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1371 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1372 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1373 @end smallexample
1374
1375 @noindent
1376 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1377 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1378 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1379
1380 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1381 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1382 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1383 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1384
1385
1386 @node Help
1387 @section Getting help
1388 @cindex online documentation
1389 @kindex help
1390
1391 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1392 using the command @code{help}.
1393
1394 @table @code
1395 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1396 @item help
1397 @itemx h
1398 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1399 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1400
1401 @smallexample
1402 (@value{GDBP}) help
1403 List of classes of commands:
1404
1405 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1406 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1407 data -- Examining data
1408 files -- Specifying and examining files
1409 internals -- Maintenance commands
1410 obscure -- Obscure features
1411 running -- Running the program
1412 stack -- Examining the stack
1413 status -- Status inquiries
1414 support -- Support facilities
1415 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1416 stopping the program
1417 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1418
1419 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1420 commands in that class.
1421 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1422 documentation.
1423 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1424 (@value{GDBP})
1425 @end smallexample
1426 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1427
1428 @item help @var{class}
1429 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1430 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1431 help display for the class @code{status}:
1432
1433 @smallexample
1434 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1435 Status inquiries.
1436
1437 List of commands:
1438
1439 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1440 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1441 info -- Generic command for showing things
1442 about the program being debugged
1443 show -- Generic command for showing things
1444 about the debugger
1445
1446 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1447 documentation.
1448 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1449 (@value{GDBP})
1450 @end smallexample
1451
1452 @item help @var{command}
1453 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1454 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1455
1456 @kindex apropos
1457 @item apropos @var{args}
1458 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1459 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1460 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1461
1462 @smallexample
1463 apropos reload
1464 @end smallexample
1465
1466 @noindent
1467 results in:
1468
1469 @smallexample
1470 @c @group
1471 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1472 multiple times in one run
1473 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1474 multiple times in one run
1475 @c @end group
1476 @end smallexample
1477
1478 @kindex complete
1479 @item complete @var{args}
1480 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1481 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1482 command you want completed. For example:
1483
1484 @smallexample
1485 complete i
1486 @end smallexample
1487
1488 @noindent results in:
1489
1490 @smallexample
1491 @group
1492 if
1493 ignore
1494 info
1495 inspect
1496 @end group
1497 @end smallexample
1498
1499 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1500 @end table
1501
1502 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1503 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1504 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1505 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1506 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1507 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1508
1509 @c @group
1510 @table @code
1511 @kindex info
1512 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1513 @item info
1514 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1515 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1516 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1517 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1518 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1519 @w{@code{help info}}.
1520
1521 @kindex set
1522 @item set
1523 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1524 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1525 @code{set prompt $}.
1526
1527 @kindex show
1528 @item show
1529 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1530 @value{GDBN} itself.
1531 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1532 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1533 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1534 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1535
1536 @kindex info set
1537 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1538 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1539 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1540 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1541 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1542 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1543 @end table
1544 @c @end group
1545
1546 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1547 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1548
1549 @table @code
1550 @kindex show version
1551 @cindex version number
1552 @item show version
1553 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1554 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1555 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1556 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1557 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1558 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1559 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1560 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1561 @value{GDBN}.
1562
1563 @kindex show copying
1564 @item show copying
1565 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1566
1567 @kindex show warranty
1568 @item show warranty
1569 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1570 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1571
1572 @end table
1573
1574 @node Running
1575 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1576
1577 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1578 debugging information when you compile it.
1579
1580 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1581 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1582 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1583 kill a child process.
1584
1585 @menu
1586 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1587 * Starting:: Starting your program
1588 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1589 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1590
1591 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1592 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1593 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1594 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1595
1596 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1597 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1598 @end menu
1599
1600 @node Compilation
1601 @section Compiling for debugging
1602
1603 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1604 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1605 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1606 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1607 and addresses in the executable code.
1608
1609 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1610 the compiler.
1611
1612 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1613 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1614 executables containing debugging information.
1615
1616 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1617 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1618 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1619 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1620 in pushing your luck.
1621
1622 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1623 @cindex debugging optimized code
1624 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1625 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1626 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1627 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1628 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1629 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1630
1631 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1632 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1633 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1634 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1635
1636 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1637 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1638 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1639
1640 @need 2000
1641 @node Starting
1642 @section Starting your program
1643 @cindex starting
1644 @cindex running
1645
1646 @table @code
1647 @kindex run
1648 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1649 @item run
1650 @itemx r
1651 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1652 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1653 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1654 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1655 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1656
1657 @end table
1658
1659 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1660 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1661 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1662 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1663
1664 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1665 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1666 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1667 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1668 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1669 divided into four categories:
1670
1671 @table @asis
1672 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1673 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1674 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1675 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1676 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1677 the arguments.
1678 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1679 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1680 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1681
1682 @item The @emph{environment.}
1683 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1684 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1685 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1686 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1687
1688 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1689 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1690 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1691 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1692
1693 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1694 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1695 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1696 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1697 set a different device for your program.
1698 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1699
1700 @cindex pipes
1701 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1702 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1703 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1704 wrong program.
1705 @end table
1706
1707 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1708 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1709 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1710 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1711 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1712
1713 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1714 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1715 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1716 your current breakpoints.
1717
1718 @node Arguments
1719 @section Your program's arguments
1720
1721 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1722 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1723 @code{run} command.
1724 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1725 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1726 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1727 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1728 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1729
1730 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1731 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1732 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1733 the program, not by the shell.
1734
1735 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1736 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1737
1738 @table @code
1739 @kindex set args
1740 @item set args
1741 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1742 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1743 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1744 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1745 it again without arguments.
1746
1747 @kindex show args
1748 @item show args
1749 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1750 @end table
1751
1752 @node Environment
1753 @section Your program's environment
1754
1755 @cindex environment (of your program)
1756 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1757 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1758 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1759 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1760 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1761 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1762 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1763
1764 @table @code
1765 @kindex path
1766 @item path @var{directory}
1767 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1768 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1769 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1770 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1771 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1772 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1773 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1774
1775 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1776 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1777 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1778 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1779 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1780 @var{directory} to the search path.
1781 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1782 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1783
1784 @kindex show paths
1785 @item show paths
1786 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1787 environment variable).
1788
1789 @kindex show environment
1790 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1791 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1792 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1793 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1794 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1795
1796 @kindex set environment
1797 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1798 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1799 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1800 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1801 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1802 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1803 null value.
1804 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1805 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1806
1807 For example, this command:
1808
1809 @smallexample
1810 set env USER = foo
1811 @end smallexample
1812
1813 @noindent
1814 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1815 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1816 are not actually required.)
1817
1818 @kindex unset environment
1819 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1820 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1821 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1822 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1823 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1824 @end table
1825
1826 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1827 the shell indicated
1828 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1829 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1830 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1831 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1832 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1833 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1834 @file{.profile}.
1835
1836 @node Working Directory
1837 @section Your program's working directory
1838
1839 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1840 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1841 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1842 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1843 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1844 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1845
1846 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1847 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1848 specify files}.
1849
1850 @table @code
1851 @kindex cd
1852 @item cd @var{directory}
1853 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1854
1855 @kindex pwd
1856 @item pwd
1857 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1858 @end table
1859
1860 @node Input/Output
1861 @section Your program's input and output
1862
1863 @cindex redirection
1864 @cindex i/o
1865 @cindex terminal
1866 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1867 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1868 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1869 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1870 running your program.
1871
1872 @table @code
1873 @kindex info terminal
1874 @item info terminal
1875 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1876 program is using.
1877 @end table
1878
1879 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1880 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1881
1882 @smallexample
1883 run > outfile
1884 @end smallexample
1885
1886 @noindent
1887 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1888
1889 @kindex tty
1890 @cindex controlling terminal
1891 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1892 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1893 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1894 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1895 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1896
1897 @smallexample
1898 tty /dev/ttyb
1899 @end smallexample
1900
1901 @noindent
1902 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1903 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1904 that as their controlling terminal.
1905
1906 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1907 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1908 terminal.
1909
1910 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1911 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1912 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1913
1914 @node Attach
1915 @section Debugging an already-running process
1916 @kindex attach
1917 @cindex attach
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @item attach @var{process-id}
1921 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1922 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1923 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1924 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1925 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1926
1927 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1928 executing the command.
1929 @end table
1930
1931 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1932 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1933 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1934 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1935
1936 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1937 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1938 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1939 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1940 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1941 Specify Files}.
1942
1943 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1944 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1945 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1946 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1947 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1948 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1949 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1950
1951 @table @code
1952 @kindex detach
1953 @item detach
1954 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1955 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1956 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1957 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1958 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1959 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1960 executing the command.
1961 @end table
1962
1963 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1964 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1965 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1966 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1967 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1968 messages}).
1969
1970 @node Kill Process
1971 @section Killing the child process
1972
1973 @table @code
1974 @kindex kill
1975 @item kill
1976 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1977 @end table
1978
1979 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1980 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1981 is running.
1982
1983 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1984 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1985 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1986 outside the debugger.
1987
1988 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1989 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1990 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1991 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1992 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1993 breakpoint settings).
1994
1995 @node Threads
1996 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1997
1998 @cindex threads of execution
1999 @cindex multiple threads
2000 @cindex switching threads
2001 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2002 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2003 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2004 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2005 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2006 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2007 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2008
2009 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2010 programs:
2011
2012 @itemize @bullet
2013 @item automatic notification of new threads
2014 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2015 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2016 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2017 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2018 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2019 @end itemize
2020
2021 @quotation
2022 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2023 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2024 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2025 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2026 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2027 like this:
2028
2029 @smallexample
2030 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2031 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2032 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2033 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2034 @end smallexample
2035 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2036 @c doesn't support threads"?
2037 @end quotation
2038
2039 @cindex focus of debugging
2040 @cindex current thread
2041 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2042 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2043 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2044 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2045 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2046
2047 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2048 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2049 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2050 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2051 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2052 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2053 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2054 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2055 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2056 LynxOS, you might see
2057
2058 @smallexample
2059 [New process 35 thread 27]
2060 @end smallexample
2061
2062 @noindent
2063 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2064 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2065 further qualifier.
2066
2067 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2068 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2069 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2070 @c program?
2071 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2072 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2073 @c threads ab initio?
2074
2075 @cindex thread number
2076 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2077 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2078 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2079
2080 @table @code
2081 @kindex info threads
2082 @item info threads
2083 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2084 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2085
2086 @enumerate
2087 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2088
2089 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2090
2091 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2092 @end enumerate
2093
2094 @noindent
2095 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2096 indicates the current thread.
2097
2098 For example,
2099 @end table
2100 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2101
2102 @smallexample
2103 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2104 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2105 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2106 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2107 at threadtest.c:68
2108 @end smallexample
2109
2110 On HP-UX systems:
2111
2112 @cindex thread number
2113 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2114 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2115 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2116 thread in your program.
2117
2118 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2119 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2120 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2121 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2122 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2123 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2124 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2125 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2126 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2127 HP-UX, you see
2128
2129 @smallexample
2130 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2131 @end smallexample
2132
2133 @noindent
2134 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2135
2136 @table @code
2137 @kindex info threads
2138 @item info threads
2139 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2140 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2141
2142 @enumerate
2143 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2144
2145 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2146
2147 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2148 @end enumerate
2149
2150 @noindent
2151 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2152 indicates the current thread.
2153
2154 For example,
2155 @end table
2156 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2157
2158 @smallexample
2159 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2160 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2161 at quicksort.c:137
2162 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2163 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2164 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2165 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2166 @end smallexample
2167
2168 @table @code
2169 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2170 @item thread @var{threadno}
2171 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2172 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2173 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2174 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2175 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2176
2177 @smallexample
2178 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2179 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2180 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2181 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2182 @end smallexample
2183
2184 @noindent
2185 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2186 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2187 threads.
2188
2189 @kindex thread apply
2190 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2191 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2192 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2193 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2194 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2195 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2196 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2197 @end table
2198
2199 @cindex automatic thread selection
2200 @cindex switching threads automatically
2201 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2202 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2203 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2204 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2205 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2206 thread.
2207
2208 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2209 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2210 programs with multiple threads.
2211
2212 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2213 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2214
2215 @node Processes
2216 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2217
2218 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2219 @cindex multiple processes
2220 @cindex processes, multiple
2221 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2222 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2223 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2224 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2225 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2226 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2227 will cause it to terminate.
2228
2229 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2230 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2231 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2232 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2233 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2234 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2235 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2236 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2237 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2238 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2239
2240 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2241 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2242 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2243
2244 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2245 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2246
2247 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2248 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2249
2250 @table @code
2251 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2252 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2253 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2254 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2255 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2256
2257 @table @code
2258 @item parent
2259 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2260 unimpeded. This is the default.
2261
2262 @item child
2263 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2264 unimpeded.
2265
2266 @item ask
2267 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2268 @end table
2269
2270 @item show follow-fork-mode
2271 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2272 @end table
2273
2274 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2275 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2276 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2277 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2278 the child process's @code{main}.
2279
2280 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2281 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2282
2283 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2284 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2285 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2286 argument.
2287
2288 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2289 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2290 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2291
2292 @node Stopping
2293 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2294
2295 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2296 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2297 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2298
2299 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2300 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2301 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2302 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2303 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2304 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2305 explicitly request this information at any time.
2306
2307 @table @code
2308 @kindex info program
2309 @item info program
2310 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2311 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2312 @end table
2313
2314 @menu
2315 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2316 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2317 * Signals:: Signals
2318 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2319 @end menu
2320
2321 @node Breakpoints
2322 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2323
2324 @cindex breakpoints
2325 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2326 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2327 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2328 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2329 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2330 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2331 program.
2332
2333 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2334 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2335 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2336 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2337 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2338 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2339
2340 @cindex watchpoints
2341 @cindex memory tracing
2342 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2343 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2344 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2345 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2346 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2347 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2348 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2349 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2350
2351 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2352 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2353 Automatic display}.
2354
2355 @cindex catchpoints
2356 @cindex breakpoint on events
2357 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2358 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2359 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2360 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2361 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2362 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2363 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2364
2365 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2366 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2367 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2368 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2369 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2370 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2371 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2372 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2373 enable it again.
2374
2375 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2376 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2377 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2378 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2379 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2380 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2381 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2382
2383 @menu
2384 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2385 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2386 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2387 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2388 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2389 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2390 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2391 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2392 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2393 @end menu
2394
2395 @node Set Breaks
2396 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2397
2398 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2399 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2400 @c
2401 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2402
2403 @kindex break
2404 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2405 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2406 @cindex latest breakpoint
2407 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2408 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2409 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2410 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2411 convenience variables.
2412
2413 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2414
2415 @table @code
2416 @item break @var{function}
2417 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2418 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2419 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2420 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2421
2422 @item break +@var{offset}
2423 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2424 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2425 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2426 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2427
2428 @item break @var{linenum}
2429 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2430 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2431 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2432 code on that line.
2433
2434 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2435 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2436
2437 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2438 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2439 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2440 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2441 functions.
2442
2443 @item break *@var{address}
2444 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2445 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2446 information or source files.
2447
2448 @item break
2449 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2450 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2451 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2452 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2453 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2454 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2455 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2456 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2457 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2458 inside loops.
2459
2460 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2461 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2462 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2463 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2464 existed when your program stopped.
2465
2466 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2467 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2468 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2469 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2470 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2471 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2472 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2473
2474 @kindex tbreak
2475 @item tbreak @var{args}
2476 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2477 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2478 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2479 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2480
2481 @kindex hbreak
2482 @item hbreak @var{args}
2483 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2484 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2485 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2486 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2487 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2488 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2489 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2490 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2491 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2492 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2493 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2494 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2495 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2496 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2497
2498 @kindex thbreak
2499 @item thbreak @var{args}
2500 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2501 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2502 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2503 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2504 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2505 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2506 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2507 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2508
2509 @kindex rbreak
2510 @cindex regular expression
2511 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2512 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2513 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2514 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2515 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2516 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2517 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2518
2519 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2520 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2521 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2522 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2523 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2524 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2525
2526 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2527 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2528 classes.
2529
2530 @kindex info breakpoints
2531 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2532 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2533 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2534 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2535 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2536 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2537
2538 @table @emph
2539 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2540 @item Type
2541 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2542 @item Disposition
2543 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2544 @item Enabled or Disabled
2545 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2546 that are not enabled.
2547 @item Address
2548 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2549 @item What
2550 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2551 line number.
2552 @end table
2553
2554 @noindent
2555 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2556 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2557 are listed after that.
2558
2559 @noindent
2560 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2561 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2562 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2563 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2564 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2565
2566 @noindent
2567 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2568 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2569 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2570 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2571 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2572 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2573 @end table
2574
2575 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2576 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2577 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2578 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2579
2580 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2581 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2582 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2583 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2584 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2585 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2586 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2587 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2588
2589
2590 @node Set Watchpoints
2591 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2592
2593 @cindex setting watchpoints
2594 @cindex software watchpoints
2595 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2596 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2597 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2598 this may happen.
2599
2600 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2601 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2602 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2603 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2604 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2605 culprit.)
2606
2607 On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2608 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2609 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2610 program.
2611
2612 @table @code
2613 @kindex watch
2614 @item watch @var{expr}
2615 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2616 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2617
2618 @kindex rwatch
2619 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2620 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2621
2622 @kindex awatch
2623 @item awatch @var{expr}
2624 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2625 by the program.
2626
2627 @kindex info watchpoints
2628 @item info watchpoints
2629 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2630 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2631 @end table
2632
2633 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2634 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2635 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2636 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2637 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2638 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2639
2640 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2641
2642 @smallexample
2643 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2644 @end smallexample
2645
2646 @noindent
2647 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2648
2649 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2650 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2651 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2652 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2653 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2654 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2655 will print a message like this:
2656
2657 @smallexample
2658 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2659 @end smallexample
2660
2661 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2662 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2663 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2664 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2665 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2666 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2667 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2668 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2669
2670 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2671 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2672 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2673 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2674 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2675 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2676
2677 @smallexample
2678 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2679 @end smallexample
2680
2681 @noindent
2682 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2683
2684 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2685 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2686 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2687 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2688 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2689 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2690 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2691 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2692 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2693 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2694
2695 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2696 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2697 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2698
2699 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2700 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2701 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2702 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2703 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2704 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2705 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2706 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2707 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2708
2709 @quotation
2710 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2711 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2712 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2713 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2714 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2715 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2716 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2717 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2718 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2719 the expression.
2720
2721 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2722 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2723 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2724 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2725 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2726 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2727 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2728 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2729 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2730 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2731 @end quotation
2732
2733 @node Set Catchpoints
2734 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2735 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2736 @cindex exception handlers
2737 @cindex event handling
2738
2739 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2740 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2741 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2742
2743 @table @code
2744 @kindex catch
2745 @item catch @var{event}
2746 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2747 @table @code
2748 @item throw
2749 @kindex catch throw
2750 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2751
2752 @item catch
2753 @kindex catch catch
2754 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2755
2756 @item exec
2757 @kindex catch exec
2758 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2759
2760 @item fork
2761 @kindex catch fork
2762 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2763
2764 @item vfork
2765 @kindex catch vfork
2766 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2767
2768 @item load
2769 @itemx load @var{libname}
2770 @kindex catch load
2771 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2772 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2773
2774 @item unload
2775 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2776 @kindex catch unload
2777 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2778 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2779 @end table
2780
2781 @item tcatch @var{event}
2782 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2783 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2784
2785 @end table
2786
2787 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2788
2789 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2790 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2791
2792 @itemize @bullet
2793 @item
2794 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2795 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2796 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2797 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2798 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2799 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2800 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2801 disabled within interactive calls.
2802
2803 @item
2804 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2805
2806 @item
2807 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2808 @end itemize
2809
2810 @cindex raise exceptions
2811 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2812 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2813 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2814 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2815 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2816 out where the exception was raised.
2817
2818 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2819 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2820 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2821 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2822
2823 @smallexample
2824 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2825 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2826 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2827 @end smallexample
2828
2829 @noindent
2830 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2831 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2832 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2833
2834 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2835 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2836 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2837 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2838 raised.
2839
2840
2841 @node Delete Breaks
2842 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2843
2844 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2845 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2846 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2847 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2848 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2849 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2850
2851 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2852 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2853 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2854 their breakpoint numbers.
2855
2856 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2857 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2858 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2859
2860 @table @code
2861 @kindex clear
2862 @item clear
2863 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2864 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2865 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2866 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2867
2868 @item clear @var{function}
2869 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2870 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2871
2872 @item clear @var{linenum}
2873 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2874 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2875
2876 @cindex delete breakpoints
2877 @kindex delete
2878 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2879 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2880 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2881 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2882 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2883 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2884 @end table
2885
2886 @node Disabling
2887 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2888
2889 @kindex disable breakpoints
2890 @kindex enable breakpoints
2891 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2892 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2893 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2894 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2895
2896 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2897 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2898 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2899 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2900 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2901
2902 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2903 states of enablement:
2904
2905 @itemize @bullet
2906 @item
2907 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2908 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2909 @item
2910 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2911 @item
2912 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2913 disabled.
2914 @item
2915 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2916 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2917 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2918 @end itemize
2919
2920 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2921 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2922
2923 @table @code
2924 @kindex disable breakpoints
2925 @kindex disable
2926 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2927 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2928 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2929 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2930 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2931 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2932 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2933
2934 @kindex enable breakpoints
2935 @kindex enable
2936 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2937 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2938 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2939
2940 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2941 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2942 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2943
2944 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2945 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2946 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2947 @end table
2948
2949 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2950 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2951 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2952 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2953 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2954 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2955 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2956 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2957 stepping}.)
2958
2959 @node Conditions
2960 @subsection Break conditions
2961 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2962 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2963
2964 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2965 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2966 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2967 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2968 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2969 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2970 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2971 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2972
2973 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2974 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2975 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2976 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2977 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2978
2979 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2980 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2981 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2982 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2983 one.
2984
2985 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2986 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2987 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2988 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2989 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2990 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2991 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
2992 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2993 conditions for the
2994 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2995 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2996
2997 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2998 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2999 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3000 with the @code{condition} command.
3001
3002 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3003 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3004 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3005 catchpoint.
3006
3007 @table @code
3008 @kindex condition
3009 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3010 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3011 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3012 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3013 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3014 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3015 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3016 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3017 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3018 prints an error message:
3019
3020 @smallexample
3021 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3022 @end smallexample
3023
3024 @noindent
3025 @value{GDBN} does
3026 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3027 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3028 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3029
3030 @item condition @var{bnum}
3031 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3032 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3033 @end table
3034
3035 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3036 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3037 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3038 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3039 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3040 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3041 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3042 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3043 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3044 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3045 your program reaches it.
3046
3047 @table @code
3048 @kindex ignore
3049 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3050 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3051 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3052 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3053 takes no action.
3054
3055 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3056 a count of zero.
3057
3058 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3059 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3060 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3061 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3062
3063 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3064 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3065 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3066
3067 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3068 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3069 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3070 variables}.
3071 @end table
3072
3073 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3074
3075
3076 @node Break Commands
3077 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3078
3079 @cindex breakpoint commands
3080 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3081 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3082 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3083 enable other breakpoints.
3084
3085 @table @code
3086 @kindex commands
3087 @kindex end
3088 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3089 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3090 @itemx end
3091 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3092 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3093 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3094
3095 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3096 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3097
3098 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3099 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3100 recently encountered).
3101 @end table
3102
3103 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3104 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3105
3106 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3107 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3108 that resumes execution.
3109
3110 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3111 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3112 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3113 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3114 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3115
3116 @kindex silent
3117 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3118 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3119 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3120 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3121 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3122 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3123
3124 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3125 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3126 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3127
3128 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3129 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3130
3131 @smallexample
3132 break foo if x>0
3133 commands
3134 silent
3135 printf "x is %d\n",x
3136 cont
3137 end
3138 @end smallexample
3139
3140 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3141 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3142 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3143 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3144 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3145 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3146 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3147
3148 @smallexample
3149 break 403
3150 commands
3151 silent
3152 set x = y + 4
3153 cont
3154 end
3155 @end smallexample
3156
3157 @node Breakpoint Menus
3158 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3159 @cindex overloading
3160 @cindex symbol overloading
3161
3162 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
3163 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3164 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3165 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3166 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3167 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3168 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3169 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3170 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3171 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3172 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3173 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3174 breakpoints.
3175
3176 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3177 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3178 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3179
3180 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3181 @smallexample
3182 @group
3183 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3184 [0] cancel
3185 [1] all
3186 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3187 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3188 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3189 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3190 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3191 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3192 > 2 4 6
3193 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3194 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3195 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3196 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3197 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3198 breakpoints.
3199 (@value{GDBP})
3200 @end group
3201 @end smallexample
3202
3203 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3204 @node Error in Breakpoints
3205 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3206 @c
3207 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3208 @c
3209 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3210 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3211 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3212 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3213
3214 @smallexample
3215 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3216 The same program may be running in another process.
3217 @end smallexample
3218
3219 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3220
3221 @enumerate
3222 @item
3223 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3224
3225 @item
3226 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3227 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3228 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3229 Then start your program again.
3230
3231 @item
3232 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3233 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3234 to nonsharable executables.
3235 @end enumerate
3236 @c @end ifclear
3237
3238 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3239 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3240
3241 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3242 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3243 @smallexample
3244 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3245 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3246 @end smallexample
3247
3248 @noindent
3249 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3250 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3251 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3252
3253 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3254 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3255
3256
3257 @node Continuing and Stepping
3258 @section Continuing and stepping
3259
3260 @cindex stepping
3261 @cindex continuing
3262 @cindex resuming execution
3263 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3264 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3265 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3266 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3267 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3268 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3269 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3270 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3271
3272 @table @code
3273 @kindex continue
3274 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3275 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3276 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3277 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3278 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3279 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3280 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3281 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3282 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3283 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3284
3285 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3286 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3287 @code{continue} is ignored.
3288
3289 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3290 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3291 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3292 @code{continue}.
3293 @end table
3294
3295 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3296 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3297 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3298 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3299
3300 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3301 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3302 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3303 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3304 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3305 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3306
3307 @table @code
3308 @kindex step
3309 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3310 @item step
3311 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3312 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3313 abbreviated @code{s}.
3314
3315 @quotation
3316 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3317 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3318 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3319 @c distinction here.
3320 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3321 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3322 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3323 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3324 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3325 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3326 below.
3327 @end quotation
3328
3329 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3330 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3331 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3332 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3333 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3334 called within the line.
3335
3336 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3337 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3338 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3339 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3340 was any debugging information about the routine.
3341
3342 @item step @var{count}
3343 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3344 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3345 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3346
3347 @kindex next
3348 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3349 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3350 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3351 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3352 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3353 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3354 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3355 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3356
3357 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3358
3359
3360 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3361 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3362 @c
3363 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3364 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3365 @c function are executed without stopping.
3366
3367 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3368 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3369 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3370
3371 @kindex set step-mode
3372 @item set step-mode
3373 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3374 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3375 @itemx set step-mode on
3376 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3377 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3378 information rather than stepping over it.
3379
3380 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3381 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3382 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3383
3384 @item set step-mode off
3385 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3386 debug information. This is the default.
3387
3388 @kindex finish
3389 @item finish
3390 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3391 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3392
3393 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3394 ,Returning from a function}).
3395
3396 @kindex until
3397 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3398 @item until
3399 @itemx u
3400 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3401 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3402 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3403 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3404 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3405 than the address of the jump.
3406
3407 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3408 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3409 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3410 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3411 through the next iteration.
3412
3413 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3414 stack frame.
3415
3416 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3417 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3418 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3419 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3420 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3421
3422 @smallexample
3423 (@value{GDBP}) f
3424 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3425 206 expand_input();
3426 (@value{GDBP}) until
3427 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3428 @end smallexample
3429
3430 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3431 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3432 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3433 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3434 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3435 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3436 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3437
3438 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3439 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3440 argument.
3441
3442 @item until @var{location}
3443 @itemx u @var{location}
3444 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3445 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3446 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3447 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3448 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3449
3450 @kindex stepi
3451 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3452 @item stepi
3453 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3454 @itemx si
3455 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3456
3457 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3458 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3459 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3460 Display,, Automatic display}.
3461
3462 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3463
3464 @need 750
3465 @kindex nexti
3466 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3467 @item nexti
3468 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3469 @itemx ni
3470 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3471 proceed until the function returns.
3472
3473 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3474 @end table
3475
3476 @node Signals
3477 @section Signals
3478 @cindex signals
3479
3480 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3481 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3482 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3483 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3484 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3485 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3486 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3487 requested an alarm).
3488
3489 @cindex fatal signals
3490 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3491 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3492 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3493 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3494 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3495 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3496
3497 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3498 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3499 signal.
3500
3501 @cindex handling signals
3502 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3503 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3504 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3505 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3506 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3507
3508 @table @code
3509 @kindex info signals
3510 @item info signals
3511 @itemx info handle
3512 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3513 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3514 the defined types of signals.
3515
3516 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3517
3518 @kindex handle
3519 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3520 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3521 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3522 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3523 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3524 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3525 @end table
3526
3527 @c @group
3528 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3529 Their full names are:
3530
3531 @table @code
3532 @item nostop
3533 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3534 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3535
3536 @item stop
3537 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3538 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3539
3540 @item print
3541 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3542
3543 @item noprint
3544 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3545 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3546
3547 @item pass
3548 @itemx noignore
3549 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3550 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3551 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3552
3553 @item nopass
3554 @itemx ignore
3555 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3556 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3557 @end table
3558 @c @end group
3559
3560 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3561 program until you
3562 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3563 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3564 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3565 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3566 program sees that signal when you continue.
3567
3568 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3569 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3570 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3571 erroneous signals.
3572
3573 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3574 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3575 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3576 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3577 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3578 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3579 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3580 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3581 program a signal}.
3582
3583 @node Thread Stops
3584 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3585
3586 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3587 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3588 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3589
3590 @table @code
3591 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3592 @cindex thread breakpoints
3593 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3594 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3595 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3596 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3597 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3598
3599 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3600 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3601 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3602 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3603 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3604
3605 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3606 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3607 program.
3608
3609 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3610 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3611 breakpoint condition, like this:
3612
3613 @smallexample
3614 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @end table
3618
3619 @cindex stopped threads
3620 @cindex threads, stopped
3621 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3622 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3623 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3624 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3625 underfoot.
3626
3627 @cindex continuing threads
3628 @cindex threads, continuing
3629 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3630 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3631 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3632
3633 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3634 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3635 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3636 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3637 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3638 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3639 stops.
3640
3641 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3642 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3643 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3644 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3645
3646 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3647 thread to run.
3648
3649 @table @code
3650 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3651 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3652 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3653 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3654 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3655 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3656 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3657 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3658 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3659 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3660 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3661 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3662
3663 @item show scheduler-locking
3664 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3665 @end table
3666
3667
3668 @node Stack
3669 @chapter Examining the Stack
3670
3671 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3672 stopped and how it got there.
3673
3674 @cindex call stack
3675 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3676 is generated.
3677 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3678 the arguments of the call,
3679 and the local variables of the function being called.
3680 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3681 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3682 stack}.
3683
3684 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3685 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3686
3687 @cindex selected frame
3688 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3689 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3690 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3691 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3692 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3693 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3694
3695 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3696 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3697 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3698
3699 @menu
3700 * Frames:: Stack frames
3701 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3702 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3703 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3704
3705 @end menu
3706
3707 @node Frames
3708 @section Stack frames
3709
3710 @cindex frame, definition
3711 @cindex stack frame
3712 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3713 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3714 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3715 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3716 which the function is executing.
3717
3718 @cindex initial frame
3719 @cindex outermost frame
3720 @cindex innermost frame
3721 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3722 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3723 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3724 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3725 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3726 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3727 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3728 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3729
3730 @cindex frame pointer
3731 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3732 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3733 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3734 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3735 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3736 going on in that frame.
3737
3738 @cindex frame number
3739 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3740 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3741 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3742 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3743 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3744
3745 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3746 @c underflow problems.
3747 @cindex frameless execution
3748 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3749 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3750 @smallexample
3751 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3752 @end smallexample
3753 generates functions without a frame.)
3754 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3755 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3756 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3757 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3758 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3759 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3760 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3761
3762 @table @code
3763 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3764 @cindex current stack frame
3765 @item frame @var{args}
3766 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3767 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3768 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3769 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3770
3771 @kindex select-frame
3772 @cindex selecting frame silently
3773 @item select-frame
3774 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3775 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3776 @code{frame}.
3777 @end table
3778
3779 @node Backtrace
3780 @section Backtraces
3781
3782 @cindex backtraces
3783 @cindex tracebacks
3784 @cindex stack traces
3785 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3786 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3787 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3788 stack.
3789
3790 @table @code
3791 @kindex backtrace
3792 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3793 @item backtrace
3794 @itemx bt
3795 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3796 frames in the stack.
3797
3798 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3799 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3800
3801 @item backtrace @var{n}
3802 @itemx bt @var{n}
3803 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3804
3805 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3806 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3807 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3808 @end table
3809
3810 @kindex where
3811 @kindex info stack
3812 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3813 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3814 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3815
3816 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3817 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3818 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3819 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3820 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3821 line number.
3822
3823 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3824 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3825
3826 @smallexample
3827 @group
3828 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3829 at builtin.c:993
3830 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3831 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3832 at macro.c:71
3833 (More stack frames follow...)
3834 @end group
3835 @end smallexample
3836
3837 @noindent
3838 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3839 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3840 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3841
3842 @node Selection
3843 @section Selecting a frame
3844
3845 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3846 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3847 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3848 of the stack frame just selected.
3849
3850 @table @code
3851 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3852 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3853 @item frame @var{n}
3854 @itemx f @var{n}
3855 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3856 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3857 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3858 @code{main}.
3859
3860 @item frame @var{addr}
3861 @itemx f @var{addr}
3862 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3863 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3864 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3865 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3866 switches between them.
3867
3868 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3869 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3870
3871 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3872 pointer and a program counter.
3873
3874 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3875 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3876 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3877 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3878 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3879
3880 @kindex up
3881 @item up @var{n}
3882 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3883 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3884 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3885
3886 @kindex down
3887 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3888 @item down @var{n}
3889 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3890 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3891 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3892 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3893 @end table
3894
3895 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3896 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3897 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3898 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3899
3900 @need 1000
3901 For example:
3902
3903 @smallexample
3904 @group
3905 (@value{GDBP}) up
3906 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3907 at env.c:10
3908 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3909 @end group
3910 @end smallexample
3911
3912 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3913 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3914 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3915
3916 @table @code
3917 @kindex down-silently
3918 @kindex up-silently
3919 @item up-silently @var{n}
3920 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3921 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3922 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3923 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3924 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3925 distracting.
3926 @end table
3927
3928 @node Frame Info
3929 @section Information about a frame
3930
3931 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3932 stack frame.
3933
3934 @table @code
3935 @item frame
3936 @itemx f
3937 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3938 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3939 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3940 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3941 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3942
3943 @kindex info frame
3944 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3945 @item info frame
3946 @itemx info f
3947 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3948 including:
3949
3950 @itemize @bullet
3951 @item
3952 the address of the frame
3953 @item
3954 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3955 @item
3956 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3957 @item
3958 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3959 @item
3960 the address of the frame's arguments
3961 @item
3962 the address of the frame's local variables
3963 @item
3964 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3965 @item
3966 which registers were saved in the frame
3967 @end itemize
3968
3969 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3970 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3971 the usual conventions.
3972
3973 @item info frame @var{addr}
3974 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3975 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3976 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3977 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3978 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3979 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3980
3981 @kindex info args
3982 @item info args
3983 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3984
3985 @item info locals
3986 @kindex info locals
3987 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3988 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3989 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3990
3991 @kindex info catch
3992 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3993 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
3994 @item info catch
3995 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3996 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3997 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3998 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3999 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4000
4001 @end table
4002
4003
4004 @node Source
4005 @chapter Examining Source Files
4006
4007 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4008 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4009 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4010 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4011 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4012 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4013 source files by explicit command.
4014
4015 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4016 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4017 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4018
4019 @menu
4020 * List:: Printing source lines
4021 * Search:: Searching source files
4022 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4023 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4024 @end menu
4025
4026 @node List
4027 @section Printing source lines
4028
4029 @kindex list
4030 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4031 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4032 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4033 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4034
4035 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4036
4037 @table @code
4038 @item list @var{linenum}
4039 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4040 current source file.
4041
4042 @item list @var{function}
4043 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4044 @var{function}.
4045
4046 @item list
4047 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4048 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4049 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4050 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4051 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4052
4053 @item list -
4054 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4055 @end table
4056
4057 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4058 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4059
4060 @table @code
4061 @kindex set listsize
4062 @item set listsize @var{count}
4063 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4064 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4065
4066 @kindex show listsize
4067 @item show listsize
4068 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4069 @end table
4070
4071 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4072 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4073 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4074 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4075 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4076
4077 @cindex linespec
4078 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4079 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4080 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4081 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4082
4083 @table @code
4084 @item list @var{linespec}
4085 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4086
4087 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4088 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4089 linespecs.
4090
4091 @item list ,@var{last}
4092 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4093
4094 @item list @var{first},
4095 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4096
4097 @item list +
4098 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4099
4100 @item list -
4101 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4102
4103 @item list
4104 As described in the preceding table.
4105 @end table
4106
4107 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4108 kinds of linespec.
4109
4110 @table @code
4111 @item @var{number}
4112 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4113 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4114 the same source file as the first linespec.
4115
4116 @item +@var{offset}
4117 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4118 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4119 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4120 first linespec.
4121
4122 @item -@var{offset}
4123 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4124
4125 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4126 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4127
4128 @item @var{function}
4129 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4130 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4131
4132 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4133 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4134 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4135 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4136 identically named functions in different source files.
4137
4138 @item *@var{address}
4139 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4140 @var{address} may be any expression.
4141 @end table
4142
4143 @node Search
4144 @section Searching source files
4145 @cindex searching
4146 @kindex reverse-search
4147
4148 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4149 regular expression.
4150
4151 @table @code
4152 @kindex search
4153 @kindex forward-search
4154 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4155 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4156 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4157 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4158 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4159 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4160 @code{fo}.
4161
4162 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4163 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4164 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4165 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4166 this command as @code{rev}.
4167 @end table
4168
4169 @node Source Path
4170 @section Specifying source directories
4171
4172 @cindex source path
4173 @cindex directories for source files
4174 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4175 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4176 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4177 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4178 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4179 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4180 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4181 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4182 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4183 path.
4184
4185 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4186 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4187 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4188 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4189 last resort.
4190
4191 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4192 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4193 each line is in the file.
4194
4195 @kindex directory
4196 @kindex dir
4197 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4198 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4199 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4200
4201 @table @code
4202 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4203 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4204 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4205 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4206 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4207 part of absolute file names) or
4208 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4209 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4210
4211 @kindex cdir
4212 @kindex cwd
4213 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4214 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4215 @cindex compilation directory
4216 @cindex current directory
4217 @cindex working directory
4218 @cindex directory, current
4219 @cindex directory, compilation
4220 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4221 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4222 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4223 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4224 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4225 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4226
4227 @item directory
4228 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4229
4230 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4231 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4232
4233 @item show directories
4234 @kindex show directories
4235 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4236 @end table
4237
4238 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4239 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4240 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4241
4242 @enumerate
4243 @item
4244 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4245
4246 @item
4247 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4248 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4249 directories in one command.
4250 @end enumerate
4251
4252 @node Machine Code
4253 @section Source and machine code
4254
4255 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4256 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4257 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4258 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4259 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4260 well as hex.
4261
4262 @table @code
4263 @kindex info line
4264 @item info line @var{linespec}
4265 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4266 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4267 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4268 source lines}).
4269 @end table
4270
4271 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4272 the object code for the first line of function
4273 @code{m4_changequote}:
4274
4275 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4276 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4277 @smallexample
4278 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4279 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4280 @end smallexample
4281
4282 @noindent
4283 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4284 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4285 @smallexample
4286 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4287 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4288 @end smallexample
4289
4290 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4291 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4292 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4293 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4294 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4295 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4296 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4297 variables}).
4298
4299 @table @code
4300 @kindex disassemble
4301 @cindex assembly instructions
4302 @cindex instructions, assembly
4303 @cindex machine instructions
4304 @cindex listing machine instructions
4305 @item disassemble
4306 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4307 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4308 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4309 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4310 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4311 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4312 @end table
4313
4314 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4315 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4316
4317 @smallexample
4318 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4319 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4320 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4321 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4322 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4323 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4324 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4325 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4326 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4327 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4328 End of assembler dump.
4329 @end smallexample
4330
4331 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4332 mnemonics or other syntax.
4333
4334 @table @code
4335 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4336 @cindex assembly instructions
4337 @cindex instructions, assembly
4338 @cindex machine instructions
4339 @cindex listing machine instructions
4340 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4341 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4342 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4343 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4344 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4345
4346 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4347 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4348 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4349 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4350 @end table
4351
4352
4353 @node Data
4354 @chapter Examining Data
4355
4356 @cindex printing data
4357 @cindex examining data
4358 @kindex print
4359 @kindex inspect
4360 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4361 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4362 @c different window or something like that.
4363 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4364 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4365 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4366 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4367 Different Languages}).
4368
4369 @table @code
4370 @item print @var{expr}
4371 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4372 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4373 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4374 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4375 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4376 formats}.
4377
4378 @item print
4379 @itemx print /@var{f}
4380 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4381 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4382 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4383 @end table
4384
4385 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4386 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4387 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4388
4389 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4390 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4391 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4392 Table}.
4393
4394 @menu
4395 * Expressions:: Expressions
4396 * Variables:: Program variables
4397 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4398 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4399 * Memory:: Examining memory
4400 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4401 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4402 * Value History:: Value history
4403 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4404 * Registers:: Registers
4405 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4406 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4407 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4408 @end menu
4409
4410 @node Expressions
4411 @section Expressions
4412
4413 @cindex expressions
4414 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4415 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4416 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4417 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4418 and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4419 by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4420
4421 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4422 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4423 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4424 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4425
4426 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4427 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4428 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4429 languages.
4430
4431 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4432 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4433
4434 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4435 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4436 at that address in memory.
4437 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4438
4439 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4440 to programming languages:
4441
4442 @table @code
4443 @item @@
4444 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4445 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4446
4447 @item ::
4448 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4449 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4450
4451 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4452 @cindex type casting memory
4453 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4454 @cindex casts, to view memory
4455 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4456 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4457 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4458 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4459 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4460 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4461 @end table
4462
4463 @node Variables
4464 @section Program variables
4465
4466 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4467 in your program.
4468
4469 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4470 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4471
4472 @itemize @bullet
4473 @item
4474 global (or file-static)
4475 @end itemize
4476
4477 @noindent or
4478
4479 @itemize @bullet
4480 @item
4481 visible according to the scope rules of the
4482 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4483 @end itemize
4484
4485 @noindent This means that in the function
4486
4487 @smallexample
4488 foo (a)
4489 int a;
4490 @{
4491 bar (a);
4492 @{
4493 int b = test ();
4494 bar (b);
4495 @}
4496 @}
4497 @end smallexample
4498
4499 @noindent
4500 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4501 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4502 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4503 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4504
4505 @cindex variable name conflict
4506 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4507 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4508 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4509 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4510 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4511 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4512 using the colon-colon notation:
4513
4514 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4515 @iftex
4516 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4517 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4518 @end iftex
4519 @smallexample
4520 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4521 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4522 @end smallexample
4523
4524 @noindent
4525 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4526 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4527 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4528 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4529
4530 @smallexample
4531 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4532 @end smallexample
4533
4534 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4535 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4536 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4537 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4538 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4539 @c conflict?? --mew
4540
4541 @cindex wrong values
4542 @cindex variable values, wrong
4543 @quotation
4544 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4545 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4546 scope, and just before exit.
4547 @end quotation
4548 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4549 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4550 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4551 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4552 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4553 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4554 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4555 variable definitions may be gone.
4556
4557 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4558 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4559 when compiling.
4560
4561 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4562 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4563 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4564 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4565 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4566 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4567 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4568
4569 @smallexample
4570 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4571 @end smallexample
4572
4573 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4574 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4575 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
4576 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4577 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4578 to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4579 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4580 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4581 information.
4582
4583
4584 @node Arrays
4585 @section Artificial arrays
4586
4587 @cindex artificial array
4588 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4589 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4590 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4591 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4592 program.
4593
4594 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4595 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4596 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4597 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4598 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4599 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4600 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4601 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4602 example. If a program says
4603
4604 @smallexample
4605 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4606 @end smallexample
4607
4608 @noindent
4609 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4610
4611 @smallexample
4612 p *array@@len
4613 @end smallexample
4614
4615 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4616 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4617 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4618 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4619 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4620
4621 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4622 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4623 The value need not be in memory:
4624 @smallexample
4625 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4626 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4627 @end smallexample
4628
4629 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4630 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4631 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4632 @smallexample
4633 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4634 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4635 @end smallexample
4636
4637 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4638 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4639 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4640 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4641 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4642 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4643 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4644 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4645 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4646 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4647
4648 @smallexample
4649 set $i = 0
4650 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4651 @key{RET}
4652 @key{RET}
4653 @dots{}
4654 @end smallexample
4655
4656 @node Output Formats
4657 @section Output formats
4658
4659 @cindex formatted output
4660 @cindex output formats
4661 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4662 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4663 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4664 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4665 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4666
4667 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4668 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4669 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4670 letters supported are:
4671
4672 @table @code
4673 @item x
4674 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4675 hexadecimal.
4676
4677 @item d
4678 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4679
4680 @item u
4681 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4682
4683 @item o
4684 Print as integer in octal.
4685
4686 @item t
4687 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4688 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4689 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4690 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4691
4692 @item a
4693 @cindex unknown address, locating
4694 @cindex locate address
4695 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4696 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4697 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4698
4699 @smallexample
4700 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4701 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4702 @end smallexample
4703
4704 @noindent
4705 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4706 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4707
4708 @item c
4709 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4710
4711 @item f
4712 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4713 using typical floating point syntax.
4714 @end table
4715
4716 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4717
4718 @smallexample
4719 p/x $pc
4720 @end smallexample
4721
4722 @noindent
4723 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4724 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4725
4726 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4727 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4728 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4729
4730 @node Memory
4731 @section Examining memory
4732
4733 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4734 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4735
4736 @cindex examining memory
4737 @table @code
4738 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4739 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4740 @itemx x @var{addr}
4741 @itemx x
4742 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4743 @end table
4744
4745 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4746 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4747 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4748 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4749 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4750
4751 @table @r
4752 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4753 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4754 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4755 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4756 @c 4.1.2.
4757
4758 @item @var{f}, the display format
4759 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4760 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4761 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4762 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4763
4764 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4765 The unit size is any of
4766
4767 @table @code
4768 @item b
4769 Bytes.
4770 @item h
4771 Halfwords (two bytes).
4772 @item w
4773 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4774 @item g
4775 Giant words (eight bytes).
4776 @end table
4777
4778 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4779 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4780 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4781
4782 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4783 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4784 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4785 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4786 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4787 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4788 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4789 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4790 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4791 a value from memory).
4792 @end table
4793
4794 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4795 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4796 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4797 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4798 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4799
4800 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4801 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4802 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4803 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4804 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4805
4806 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4807 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4808 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4809 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4810 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4811 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4812
4813 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4814 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4815 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4816 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4817 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4818 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4819 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4820
4821 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4822 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4823 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4824 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4825 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4826 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4827 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4828 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4829 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4830
4831 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4832 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4833 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4834
4835 @node Auto Display
4836 @section Automatic display
4837 @cindex automatic display
4838 @cindex display of expressions
4839
4840 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4841 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4842 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4843 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4844 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4845 The automatic display looks like this:
4846
4847 @smallexample
4848 2: foo = 38
4849 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4850 @end smallexample
4851
4852 @noindent
4853 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4854 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4855 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4856 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4857 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4858 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4859 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4860
4861 @table @code
4862 @kindex display
4863 @item display @var{expr}
4864 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4865 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4866
4867 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4868
4869 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4870 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4871 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4872 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4873 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4874
4875 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4876 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4877 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4878 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4879 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4880 @end table
4881
4882 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4883 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4884 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4885
4886 @table @code
4887 @kindex delete display
4888 @kindex undisplay
4889 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4890 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4891 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4892
4893 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4894 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4895
4896 @kindex disable display
4897 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4898 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4899 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4900 enabled again later.
4901
4902 @kindex enable display
4903 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4904 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4905 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4906
4907 @item display
4908 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4909 done when your program stops.
4910
4911 @kindex info display
4912 @item info display
4913 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4914 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4915 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4916 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4917 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4918 @end table
4919
4920 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4921 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4922 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4923 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4924 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4925 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4926 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4927 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4928 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4929 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4930
4931 @node Print Settings
4932 @section Print settings
4933
4934 @cindex format options
4935 @cindex print settings
4936 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4937 and symbols are printed.
4938
4939 @noindent
4940 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4941
4942 @table @code
4943 @kindex set print address
4944 @item set print address
4945 @itemx set print address on
4946 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4947 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4948 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4949 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4950 @code{set print address on}:
4951
4952 @smallexample
4953 @group
4954 (@value{GDBP}) f
4955 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4956 at input.c:530
4957 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4958 @end group
4959 @end smallexample
4960
4961 @item set print address off
4962 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4963 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4964
4965 @smallexample
4966 @group
4967 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4968 (@value{GDBP}) f
4969 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4970 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4971 @end group
4972 @end smallexample
4973
4974 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4975 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4976 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4977 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4978
4979 @kindex show print address
4980 @item show print address
4981 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4982 @end table
4983
4984 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4985 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4986 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4987 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4988 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4989 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4990 it prints a symbolic address:
4991
4992 @table @code
4993 @kindex set print symbol-filename
4994 @item set print symbol-filename on
4995 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4996 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4997
4998 @item set print symbol-filename off
4999 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5000 default.
5001
5002 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5003 @item show print symbol-filename
5004 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5005 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5006 @end table
5007
5008 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5009 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5010 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5011
5012 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5013 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5017 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5018 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5019 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5020 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5021 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5022
5023 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5024 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5025 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5026 symbolic address.
5027 @end table
5028
5029 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5030 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5031 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5032 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5033 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5034 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5035 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5036 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5037
5038 @smallexample
5039 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5040 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5041 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5042 @end smallexample
5043
5044 @quotation
5045 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5046 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5047 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5048 @end quotation
5049
5050 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5051
5052 @table @code
5053 @kindex set print array
5054 @item set print array
5055 @itemx set print array on
5056 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5057 but uses more space. The default is off.
5058
5059 @item set print array off
5060 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5061
5062 @kindex show print array
5063 @item show print array
5064 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5065 arrays.
5066
5067 @kindex set print elements
5068 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5069 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5070 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5071 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5072 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5073 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5074 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5075
5076 @kindex show print elements
5077 @item show print elements
5078 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5079 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5080
5081 @kindex set print null-stop
5082 @item set print null-stop
5083 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5084 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5085 contain only short strings.
5086 The default is off.
5087
5088 @kindex set print pretty
5089 @item set print pretty on
5090 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5091 per line, like this:
5092
5093 @smallexample
5094 @group
5095 $1 = @{
5096 next = 0x0,
5097 flags = @{
5098 sweet = 1,
5099 sour = 1
5100 @},
5101 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5102 @}
5103 @end group
5104 @end smallexample
5105
5106 @item set print pretty off
5107 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5108
5109 @smallexample
5110 @group
5111 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5112 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5113 @end group
5114 @end smallexample
5115
5116 @noindent
5117 This is the default format.
5118
5119 @kindex show print pretty
5120 @item show print pretty
5121 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5122
5123 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5124 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5125 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5126 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5127 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5128 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5129 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5130
5131 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5132 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5133 international character sets, and is the default.
5134
5135 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5136 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5137 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5138
5139 @kindex set print union
5140 @item set print union on
5141 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5142 is the default setting.
5143
5144 @item set print union off
5145 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5146
5147 @kindex show print union
5148 @item show print union
5149 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5150 structures.
5151
5152 For example, given the declarations
5153
5154 @smallexample
5155 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5156 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5157 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5158 Bug_forms;
5159
5160 struct thing @{
5161 Species it;
5162 union @{
5163 Tree_forms tree;
5164 Bug_forms bug;
5165 @} form;
5166 @};
5167
5168 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5169 @end smallexample
5170
5171 @noindent
5172 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5173
5174 @smallexample
5175 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5176 @end smallexample
5177
5178 @noindent
5179 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5180
5181 @smallexample
5182 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5183 @end smallexample
5184 @end table
5185
5186 @need 1000
5187 @noindent
5188 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5189
5190 @table @code
5191 @cindex demangling
5192 @kindex set print demangle
5193 @item set print demangle
5194 @itemx set print demangle on
5195 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5196 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5197 linkage. The default is on.
5198
5199 @kindex show print demangle
5200 @item show print demangle
5201 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5202
5203 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5204 @item set print asm-demangle
5205 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5206 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5207 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5208 The default is off.
5209
5210 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5211 @item show print asm-demangle
5212 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5213 or demangled form.
5214
5215 @kindex set demangle-style
5216 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5217 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5218 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5219 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5220 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5221
5222 @table @code
5223 @item auto
5224 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5225
5226 @item gnu
5227 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5228 This is the default.
5229
5230 @item hp
5231 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5232
5233 @item lucid
5234 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5235
5236 @item arm
5237 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5238 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5239 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5240 require further enhancement to permit that.
5241
5242 @end table
5243 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5244
5245 @kindex show demangle-style
5246 @item show demangle-style
5247 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5248
5249 @kindex set print object
5250 @item set print object
5251 @itemx set print object on
5252 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5253 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5254 the virtual function table.
5255
5256 @item set print object off
5257 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5258 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5259
5260 @kindex show print object
5261 @item show print object
5262 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5263
5264 @kindex set print static-members
5265 @item set print static-members
5266 @itemx set print static-members on
5267 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5268
5269 @item set print static-members off
5270 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5271
5272 @kindex show print static-members
5273 @item show print static-members
5274 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5275
5276 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5277 @kindex set print vtbl
5278 @item set print vtbl
5279 @itemx set print vtbl on
5280 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5281 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5282 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5283
5284 @item set print vtbl off
5285 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5286
5287 @kindex show print vtbl
5288 @item show print vtbl
5289 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5290 @end table
5291
5292 @node Value History
5293 @section Value history
5294
5295 @cindex value history
5296 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5297 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5298 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5299 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5300 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5301 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5302 symbol table.
5303
5304 @cindex @code{$}
5305 @cindex @code{$$}
5306 @cindex history number
5307 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5308 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5309 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5310 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5311 history number.
5312
5313 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5314 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5315 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5316 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5317 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5318 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5319 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5320
5321 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5322 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5323
5324 @smallexample
5325 p *$
5326 @end smallexample
5327
5328 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5329 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5330
5331 @smallexample
5332 p *$.next
5333 @end smallexample
5334
5335 @noindent
5336 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5337 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5338
5339 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5340 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5341
5342 @smallexample
5343 print x
5344 set x=5
5345 @end smallexample
5346
5347 @noindent
5348 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5349 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5350
5351 @table @code
5352 @kindex show values
5353 @item show values
5354 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5355 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5356 values} does not change the history.
5357
5358 @item show values @var{n}
5359 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5360
5361 @item show values +
5362 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5363 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5364 @end table
5365
5366 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5367 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5368
5369 @node Convenience Vars
5370 @section Convenience variables
5371
5372 @cindex convenience variables
5373 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5374 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5375 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5376 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5377 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5378
5379 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5380 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5381 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5382 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5383 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5384
5385 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5386 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5387 For example:
5388
5389 @smallexample
5390 set $foo = *object_ptr
5391 @end smallexample
5392
5393 @noindent
5394 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5395 @code{object_ptr}.
5396
5397 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5398 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5399 value with another assignment at any time.
5400
5401 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5402 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5403 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5404 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5405
5406 @table @code
5407 @kindex show convenience
5408 @item show convenience
5409 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5410 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5411 @end table
5412
5413 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5414 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5415 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5416
5417 @smallexample
5418 set $i = 0
5419 print bar[$i++]->contents
5420 @end smallexample
5421
5422 @noindent
5423 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5424
5425 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5426 values likely to be useful.
5427
5428 @table @code
5429 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5430 @item $_
5431 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5432 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5433 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5434 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5435 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5436 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5437 to the type of @code{$__}.
5438
5439 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5440 @item $__
5441 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5442 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5443 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5444
5445 @item $_exitcode
5446 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5447 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5448 the program being debugged terminates.
5449 @end table
5450
5451 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5452 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5453 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5454
5455 @node Registers
5456 @section Registers
5457
5458 @cindex registers
5459 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5460 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5461 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5462 your machine.
5463
5464 @table @code
5465 @kindex info registers
5466 @item info registers
5467 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5468 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5469
5470 @kindex info all-registers
5471 @cindex floating point registers
5472 @item info all-registers
5473 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5474 registers.
5475
5476 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5477 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5478 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5479 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5480 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5481 @end table
5482
5483 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5484 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5485 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5486 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5487 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5488 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5489 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5490 you could print the program counter in hex with
5491
5492 @smallexample
5493 p/x $pc
5494 @end smallexample
5495
5496 @noindent
5497 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5498
5499 @smallexample
5500 x/i $pc
5501 @end smallexample
5502
5503 @noindent
5504 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5505 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5506 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5507 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5508 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5509 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5510 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5511
5512 @smallexample
5513 set $sp += 4
5514 @end smallexample
5515
5516 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5517 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5518 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5519 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5520 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5521 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5522 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5523
5524 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5525 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5526 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5527 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5528 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5529 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5530 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5531
5532 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5533 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5534 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5535 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5536 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5537 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5538 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5539 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5540 prints the data in both formats.
5541
5542 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5543 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5544 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5545 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5546 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5547 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5548
5549 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5550 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5551 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5552 frame makes no difference.
5553
5554 @node Floating Point Hardware
5555 @section Floating point hardware
5556 @cindex floating point
5557
5558 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5559 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5560
5561 @table @code
5562 @kindex info float
5563 @item info float
5564 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5565 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5566 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5567 the ARM and x86 machines.
5568 @end table
5569
5570 @node Memory Region Attributes
5571 @section Memory region attributes
5572 @cindex memory region attributes
5573
5574 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5575 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5576 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5577 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5578
5579 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5580 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5581 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5582 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5583 all memory.
5584
5585 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5586 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5587
5588 @table @code
5589 @kindex mem
5590 @item mem @var{address1} @var{address2} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5591 Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5592 with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5593
5594 @kindex delete mem
5595 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5596 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5597
5598 @kindex disable mem
5599 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5600 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5601 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5602 It may be enabled again later.
5603
5604 @kindex enable mem
5605 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5606 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5607
5608 @kindex info mem
5609 @item info mem
5610 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5611 for each region.
5612
5613 @table @emph
5614 @item Memory Region Number
5615 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5616 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5617 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5618
5619 @item Lo Address
5620 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5621
5622 @item Hi Address
5623 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5624
5625 @item Attributes
5626 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5627 @end table
5628 @end table
5629
5630
5631 @subsection Attributes
5632
5633 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5634 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5635 write accesses to a memory region.
5636
5637 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5638 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5639 etc. from accessing memory.
5640
5641 @table @code
5642 @item ro
5643 Memory is read only.
5644 @item wo
5645 Memory is write only.
5646 @item rw
5647 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5648 @end table
5649
5650 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5651 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5652 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5653 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5654 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5655
5656 @table @code
5657 @item 8
5658 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5659 @item 16
5660 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5661 @item 32
5662 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5663 @item 64
5664 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5665 @end table
5666
5667 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5668 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5669 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5670 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5671 @c
5672 @c @table @code
5673 @c @item hwbreak
5674 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5675 @c @item swbreak (default)
5676 @c @end table
5677
5678 @subsubsection Data Cache
5679 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5680 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5681 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5682 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5683 registers.
5684
5685 @table @code
5686 @item cache
5687 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5688 @item nocache
5689 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5690 @end table
5691
5692 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5693 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5694 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5695 @c
5696 @c @table @code
5697 @c @item verify
5698 @c @item noverify (default)
5699 @c @end table
5700
5701 @node Dump/Restore Files
5702 @section Copy between memory and a file
5703 @cindex dump/restore files
5704 @cindex append data to a file
5705 @cindex dump data to a file
5706 @cindex restore data from a file
5707 @kindex dump
5708 @kindex append
5709 @kindex restore
5710
5711 The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5712 for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5713 into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5714 file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5715 intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5716
5717 @table @code
5718 @kindex dump binary
5719 @kindex append binary
5720 @item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5721 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5722 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5723
5724 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5725 Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5726 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5727
5728 @item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5729 Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5730
5731 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5732 Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5733
5734 @kindex dump ihex
5735 @item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5736 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5737 intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5738
5739 @item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5740 Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5741
5742 @kindex dump srec
5743 @item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5744 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5745 srec format file @var{filename}.
5746
5747 @item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5748 Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5749
5750 @kindex dump tekhex
5751 @item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5752 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5753 tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5754
5755 @item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5756 Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5757
5758 @item restore @var{filename} @var{[binary]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
5759 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5760 command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5761 raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5762 @var{binary} after the filename.
5763
5764 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5765 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5766 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5767 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5768 from that location.
5769
5770 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5771 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5772 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5773 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5774
5775 @end table
5776
5777 @node Tracepoints
5778 @chapter Tracepoints
5779 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5780 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5781
5782 @cindex tracepoints
5783 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5784 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5785 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5786 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5787 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5788 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5789 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5790
5791 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5792 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5793 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5794 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5795 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5796 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5797 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5798 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5799 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5800 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5801 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5802
5803 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5804 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
5805 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
5806 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
5807 tracepoints as of this writing.
5808
5809 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5810
5811 @menu
5812 * Set Tracepoints::
5813 * Analyze Collected Data::
5814 * Tracepoint Variables::
5815 @end menu
5816
5817 @node Set Tracepoints
5818 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5819
5820 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5821 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5822 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5823 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5824 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5825 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5826 work on.
5827
5828 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5829 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5830 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5831 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5832 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5833 tracepoint was hit.
5834
5835 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5836 conditions and actions.
5837
5838 @menu
5839 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5840 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5841 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
5842 * Tracepoint Actions::
5843 * Listing Tracepoints::
5844 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5845 @end menu
5846
5847 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5848 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5849
5850 @table @code
5851 @cindex set tracepoint
5852 @kindex trace
5853 @item trace
5854 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5855 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5856 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5857 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5858 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5859 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5860 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5861 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5862 running.
5863
5864 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5865
5866 @smallexample
5867 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5868
5869 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5870
5871 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5872
5873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5874
5875 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5876 @end smallexample
5877
5878 @noindent
5879 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5880
5881 @vindex $tpnum
5882 @cindex last tracepoint number
5883 @cindex recent tracepoint number
5884 @cindex tracepoint number
5885 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5886 of the most recently set tracepoint.
5887
5888 @kindex delete tracepoint
5889 @cindex tracepoint deletion
5890 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5891 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5892 default is to delete all tracepoints.
5893
5894 Examples:
5895
5896 @smallexample
5897 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5898
5899 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5900 @end smallexample
5901
5902 @noindent
5903 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5904 @end table
5905
5906 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5907 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5908
5909 @table @code
5910 @kindex disable tracepoint
5911 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5912 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5913 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5914 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5915 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5916
5917 @kindex enable tracepoint
5918 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5919 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5920 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5921 run.
5922 @end table
5923
5924 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
5925 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5926
5927 @table @code
5928 @kindex passcount
5929 @cindex tracepoint pass count
5930 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5931 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5932 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5933 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5934 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5935 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5936 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5937 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5938 user.
5939
5940 Examples:
5941
5942 @smallexample
5943 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
5944 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
5945
5946 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5947 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
5948 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5950 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5951 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5952 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5953 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5954 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
5955 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
5956 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
5957 @end smallexample
5958 @end table
5959
5960 @node Tracepoint Actions
5961 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5962
5963 @table @code
5964 @kindex actions
5965 @cindex tracepoint actions
5966 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5967 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5968 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5969 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5970 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5971 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5972 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5973 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5974 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5975 @code{while-stepping}.
5976
5977 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5978 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5979 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5980
5981 @smallexample
5982 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5983
5984 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
5985
5986 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5987 @end smallexample
5988
5989 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5990 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5991 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5992 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5993 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5994 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5995 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5996 @code{end} command.
5997
5998 @smallexample
5999 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6000 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6001 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6002 > collect bar,baz
6003 > collect $regs
6004 > while-stepping 12
6005 > collect $fp, $sp
6006 > end
6007 end
6008 @end smallexample
6009
6010 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6011 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6012 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6013 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6014 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6015 special arguments are supported:
6016
6017 @table @code
6018 @item $regs
6019 collect all registers
6020
6021 @item $args
6022 collect all function arguments
6023
6024 @item $locals
6025 collect all local variables.
6026 @end table
6027
6028 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6029 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6030 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6031
6032 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6033 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6034
6035 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6036 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6037 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6038 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6039 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6040 its own @code{end} command):
6041
6042 @smallexample
6043 > while-stepping 12
6044 > collect $regs, myglobal
6045 > end
6046 >
6047 @end smallexample
6048
6049 @noindent
6050 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6051 @code{stepping}.
6052 @end table
6053
6054 @node Listing Tracepoints
6055 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6056
6057 @table @code
6058 @kindex info tracepoints
6059 @cindex information about tracepoints
6060 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6061 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6062 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6063 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6064 shown:
6065
6066 @itemize @bullet
6067 @item
6068 its number
6069 @item
6070 whether it is enabled or disabled
6071 @item
6072 its address
6073 @item
6074 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6075 @item
6076 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6077 @item
6078 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6079 @item
6080 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6081 @end itemize
6082
6083 @smallexample
6084 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6085 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6086 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6087 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6088 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6089 (@value{GDBP})
6090 @end smallexample
6091
6092 @noindent
6093 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6094 @end table
6095
6096 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6097 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6098
6099 @table @code
6100 @kindex tstart
6101 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6102 @cindex collected data discarded
6103 @item tstart
6104 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6105 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6106 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6107 experiment.
6108
6109 @kindex tstop
6110 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6111 @item tstop
6112 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6113 stops collecting data.
6114
6115 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6116 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6117 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6118
6119 @kindex tstatus
6120 @cindex status of trace data collection
6121 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6122 @item tstatus
6123 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6124 collection.
6125 @end table
6126
6127 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6128
6129 @smallexample
6130 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6131 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6132 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6133 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6134 > while-stepping 11
6135 > collect $regs
6136 > end
6137 > end
6138 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6139 [time passes @dots{}]
6140 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6141 @end smallexample
6142
6143
6144 @node Analyze Collected Data
6145 @section Using the collected data
6146
6147 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6148 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6149 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6150 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6151 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6152 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6153 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6154 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6155 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6156 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6157 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6158 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6159 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6160 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6161 the buffer will fail.
6162
6163 @menu
6164 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6165 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6166 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6167 @end menu
6168
6169 @node tfind
6170 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6171
6172 @kindex tfind
6173 @cindex select trace snapshot
6174 @cindex find trace snapshot
6175 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6176 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6177 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6178 snapshot is selected.
6179
6180 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6181
6182 @table @code
6183 @item tfind start
6184 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6185 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6186
6187 @item tfind none
6188 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6189
6190 @item tfind end
6191 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6192
6193 @item tfind
6194 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6195
6196 @item tfind -
6197 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6198 retracing earlier steps.
6199
6200 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6201 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6202 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6203 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6204 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6205
6206 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6207 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6208 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6209 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6210 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6211
6212 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6213 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6214 addresses.
6215
6216 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6217 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6218 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6219
6220 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6221 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6222 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6223 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6224 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6225 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6226 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6227 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6228 @end table
6229
6230 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6231 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6232 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6233 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6234 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6235 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6236 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6237 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6238 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6239 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6240 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6241 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6242 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6243 tracepoint as the current one.
6244
6245 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6246 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6247 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6248 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6249 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6250
6251 @smallexample
6252 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6253 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6254 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6255 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6256 > tfind
6257 > end
6258
6259 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6260 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6261 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6262 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6263 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6264 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6265 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6266 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6267 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6268 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6269 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6270 @end smallexample
6271
6272 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6273 the buffer:
6274
6275 @smallexample
6276 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6277 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6278 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6279 > tfind line
6280 > end
6281
6282 Frame 0, X = 1
6283 Frame 7, X = 2
6284 Frame 13, X = 255
6285 @end smallexample
6286
6287 @node tdump
6288 @subsection @code{tdump}
6289 @kindex tdump
6290 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6291 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6292
6293 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6294 the current trace snapshot.
6295
6296 @smallexample
6297 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6298 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6299 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6300 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6301 > end
6302
6303 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6304
6305 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6306 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6307 at gdb_test.c:444
6308 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6309
6310 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6311 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6312 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6313 d1 0x18 24
6314 d2 0x80 128
6315 d3 0x33 51
6316 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6317 d5 0x22 34
6318 d6 0xe0 224
6319 d7 0x380035 3670069
6320 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6321 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6322 a2 0x100 256
6323 a3 0x322000 3284992
6324 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6325 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6326 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6327 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6328 ps 0x0 0
6329 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6330 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6331 fpstatus 0x0 0
6332 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6333 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6334 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6335 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6336 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6337 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6338 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6339 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6340 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6341
6342 (@value{GDBP})
6343 @end smallexample
6344
6345 @node save-tracepoints
6346 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6347 @kindex save-tracepoints
6348 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6349
6350 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6351 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6352 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6353 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6354 Files}).
6355
6356 @node Tracepoint Variables
6357 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6358 @cindex tracepoint variables
6359 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6360
6361 @table @code
6362 @vindex $trace_frame
6363 @item (int) $trace_frame
6364 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6365 snapshot is selected.
6366
6367 @vindex $tracepoint
6368 @item (int) $tracepoint
6369 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6370
6371 @vindex $trace_line
6372 @item (int) $trace_line
6373 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6374
6375 @vindex $trace_file
6376 @item (char []) $trace_file
6377 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6378
6379 @vindex $trace_func
6380 @item (char []) $trace_func
6381 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6382 @end table
6383
6384 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6385 use @code{output} instead.
6386
6387 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6388 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6389 data.
6390
6391 @smallexample
6392 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6393
6394 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6395 > output $trace_file
6396 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6397 > tfind
6398 > end
6399 @end smallexample
6400
6401 @node Overlays
6402 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6403 @cindex overlays
6404
6405 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6406 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6407 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6408 use overlays.
6409
6410 @menu
6411 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6412 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6413 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6414 mapped by asking the inferior.
6415 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6416 @end menu
6417
6418 @node How Overlays Work
6419 @section How Overlays Work
6420 @cindex mapped overlays
6421 @cindex unmapped overlays
6422 @cindex load address, overlay's
6423 @cindex mapped address
6424 @cindex overlay area
6425
6426 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
6427 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
6428 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
6429 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
6430 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
6431
6432 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
6433 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
6434 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
6435 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
6436 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
6437 largest overlay as well.
6438
6439 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
6440 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
6441 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
6442 there.
6443
6444 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
6445 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
6446 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
6447
6448 @smallexample
6449 @group
6450 Data Instruction Larger
6451 Address Space Address Space Address Space
6452 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
6453 | | | | | |
6454 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
6455 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
6456 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
6457 | and heap | | | | | |
6458 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
6459 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
6460 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
6461 | | | | | |
6462 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
6463 address | | | | | |
6464 | overlay | <-' | | |
6465 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
6466 | | <---. | | load address
6467 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
6468 | | | |
6469 +-----------+ | |
6470 +-----------+
6471 | |
6472 +-----------+
6473
6474 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
6475 @end group
6476 @end smallexample
6477
6478 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
6479 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
6480 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
6481 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
6482 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
6483 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
6484 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
6485 program and the overlay area.
6486
6487 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
6488 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
6489 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
6490 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
6491 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
6492 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
6493 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
6494
6495 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
6496 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
6497 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
6498
6499 @itemize @bullet
6500
6501 @item
6502 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
6503 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
6504 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
6505 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
6506
6507 @item
6508 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
6509 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
6510 your program's performance.
6511
6512 @item
6513 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
6514 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
6515 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
6516 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
6517 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
6518 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
6519 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
6520
6521 @item
6522 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
6523 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
6524 instruction and data spaces.
6525
6526 @end itemize
6527
6528 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
6529 improved in many ways:
6530
6531 @itemize @bullet
6532
6533 @item
6534 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
6535 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
6536 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
6537 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
6538 area in the usual way.
6539
6540 @item
6541 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
6542 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
6543
6544 @item
6545 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
6546 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
6547 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
6548 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
6549 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
6550 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
6551 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
6552
6553 @end itemize
6554
6555
6556 @node Overlay Commands
6557 @section Overlay Commands
6558
6559 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
6560 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
6561 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
6562 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
6563 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
6564 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
6565
6566 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
6567 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
6568
6569 @table @code
6570 @item overlay off
6571 @kindex overlay off
6572 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
6573 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
6574 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
6575 overlay support is disabled.
6576
6577 @item overlay manual
6578 @kindex overlay manual
6579 @cindex manual overlay debugging
6580 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6581 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
6582 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
6583 commands described below.
6584
6585 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
6586 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
6587 @kindex overlay map-overlay
6588 @cindex map an overlay
6589 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
6590 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
6591 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
6592 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
6593 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
6594 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
6595
6596 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
6597 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
6598 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
6599 @cindex unmap an overlay
6600 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
6601 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
6602 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
6603 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
6604
6605 @item overlay auto
6606 @kindex overlay auto
6607 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6608 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
6609 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
6610 Overlay Debugging}.
6611
6612 @item overlay load-target
6613 @itemx overlay load
6614 @kindex overlay load-target
6615 @cindex reloading the overlay table
6616 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
6617 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
6618 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
6619 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
6620 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
6621
6622 @item overlay list-overlays
6623 @itemx overlay list
6624 @cindex listing mapped overlays
6625 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
6626 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
6627
6628 @end table
6629
6630 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
6631 of the function the address falls in:
6632
6633 @smallexample
6634 (gdb) print main
6635 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
6636 @end smallexample
6637 @noindent
6638 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
6639 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
6640 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
6641 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
6642
6643 @smallexample
6644 (gdb) overlay list
6645 No sections are mapped.
6646 (gdb) print foo
6647 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
6648 @end smallexample
6649 @noindent
6650 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
6651 name normally:
6652
6653 @smallexample
6654 (gdb) overlay list
6655 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
6656 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
6657 (gdb) print foo
6658 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
6659 @end smallexample
6660
6661 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
6662 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
6663 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
6664 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
6665 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
6666
6667 @itemize @bullet
6668 @item
6669 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
6670 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
6671 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
6672 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
6673 @item
6674 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
6675 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
6676 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
6677 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
6678 breakpoints properly.
6679 @end itemize
6680
6681
6682 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
6683 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
6684 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
6685
6686 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
6687 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
6688 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
6689 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
6690 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
6691 current state of the overlays.
6692
6693 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
6694 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
6695
6696 @table @asis
6697
6698 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
6699 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
6700
6701 @smallexample
6702 struct
6703 @{
6704 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
6705 unsigned long vma;
6706
6707 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
6708 unsigned long size;
6709
6710 /* The overlay's load address. */
6711 unsigned long lma;
6712
6713 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
6714 zero otherwise. */
6715 unsigned long mapped;
6716 @}
6717 @end smallexample
6718
6719 @item @code{_novlys}:
6720 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
6721 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
6722
6723 @end table
6724
6725 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
6726 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
6727 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
6728 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
6729 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
6730 currently mapped.
6731
6732 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
6733 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
6734 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
6735 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
6736 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
6737 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
6738 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
6739 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
6740 are not being executed.
6741
6742 @node Overlay Sample Program
6743 @section Overlay Sample Program
6744 @cindex overlay example program
6745
6746 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
6747 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
6748 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
6749 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
6750 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
6751 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
6752 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
6753
6754 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
6755 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
6756 suite. The program consists of the following files from
6757 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
6758
6759 @table @file
6760 @item overlays.c
6761 The main program file.
6762 @item ovlymgr.c
6763 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
6764 @item foo.c
6765 @itemx bar.c
6766 @itemx baz.c
6767 @itemx grbx.c
6768 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
6769 @item d10v.ld
6770 @itemx m32r.ld
6771 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
6772 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
6773 @end table
6774
6775 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
6776 cross-compiler like this:
6777
6778 @smallexample
6779 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
6780 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
6781 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
6782 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
6783 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
6784 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
6785 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
6786 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
6787 @end smallexample
6788
6789 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
6790 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
6791 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
6792
6793
6794 @node Languages
6795 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6796 @cindex languages
6797
6798 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6799 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6800 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6801 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
6802 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
6803 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
6804
6805 @cindex working language
6806 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6807 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6808 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6809 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6810 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6811 language}.
6812
6813 @menu
6814 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
6815 * Show:: Displaying the language
6816 * Checks:: Type and range checks
6817 * Support:: Supported languages
6818 @end menu
6819
6820 @node Setting
6821 @section Switching between source languages
6822
6823 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6824 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6825 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6826 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6827 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6828 are printed, etc.
6829
6830 In addition to the working language, every source file that
6831 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6832 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6833 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6834 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
6835 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
6836 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
6837 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6838 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6839 Displaying the language}.
6840
6841 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
6842 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
6843 another language. In that case, make the
6844 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6845 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6846 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6847
6848 @menu
6849 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6850 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6851 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6852 @end menu
6853
6854 @node Filenames
6855 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6856
6857 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6858 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6859
6860 @table @file
6861
6862 @item .c
6863 C source file
6864
6865 @item .C
6866 @itemx .cc
6867 @itemx .cp
6868 @itemx .cpp
6869 @itemx .cxx
6870 @itemx .c++
6871 C@t{++} source file
6872
6873 @item .f
6874 @itemx .F
6875 Fortran source file
6876
6877 @item .ch
6878 @itemx .c186
6879 @itemx .c286
6880 CHILL source file
6881
6882 @item .mod
6883 Modula-2 source file
6884
6885 @item .s
6886 @itemx .S
6887 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6888 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6889 @end table
6890
6891 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6892 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6893
6894 @node Manually
6895 @subsection Setting the working language
6896
6897 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6898 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6899 your program.
6900
6901 @kindex set language
6902 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6903 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
6904 a language, such as
6905 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
6906 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6907
6908 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6909 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6910 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6911 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6912 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6913 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6914 command such as:
6915
6916 @smallexample
6917 print a = b + c
6918 @end smallexample
6919
6920 @noindent
6921 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6922 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6923 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6924 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
6925
6926 @node Automatically
6927 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6928
6929 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6930 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6931 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6932 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6933 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6934 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6935 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6936 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6937 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6938
6939 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6940 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6941 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6942 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6943 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6944
6945 @node Show
6946 @section Displaying the language
6947
6948 The following commands help you find out which language is the
6949 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6950
6951 @kindex show language
6952 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6953 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
6954 @table @code
6955 @item show language
6956 Display the current working language. This is the
6957 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6958 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6959
6960 @item info frame
6961 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
6962 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
6963 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
6964 information listed here.
6965
6966 @item info source
6967 Display the source language of this source file.
6968 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
6969 information listed here.
6970 @end table
6971
6972 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6973 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6974 with a language explicitly:
6975
6976 @kindex set extension-language
6977 @kindex info extensions
6978 @table @code
6979 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6980 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6981 the source language @var{language}.
6982
6983 @item info extensions
6984 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6985 @end table
6986
6987 @node Checks
6988 @section Type and range checking
6989
6990 @quotation
6991 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6992 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6993 section documents the intended facilities.
6994 @end quotation
6995 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6996
6997 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6998 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6999 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7000 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7001 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7002 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7003 errors when your program is running.
7004
7005 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7006 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7007 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7008 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7009 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7010 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7011 for the default settings of supported languages.
7012
7013 @menu
7014 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7015 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7016 @end menu
7017
7018 @cindex type checking
7019 @cindex checks, type
7020 @node Type Checking
7021 @subsection An overview of type checking
7022
7023 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7024 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7025 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7026 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7027
7028 @smallexample
7029 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7030 @exdent but
7031 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7032 @end smallexample
7033
7034 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7035 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7036
7037 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7038 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7039 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7040 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7041 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7042 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7043 also issues a warning.
7044
7045 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7046 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7047 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7048 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7049 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7050 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7051
7052 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7053 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7054 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7055 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7056 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7057 details on specific languages.
7058
7059 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7060
7061 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7062 @kindex set check type
7063 @kindex show check type
7064 @table @code
7065 @item set check type auto
7066 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7067 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7068 each language.
7069
7070 @item set check type on
7071 @itemx set check type off
7072 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7073 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7074 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7075 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7076 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7077
7078 @item set check type warn
7079 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7080 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7081 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7082 numbers and structures.
7083
7084 @item show type
7085 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7086 is setting it automatically.
7087 @end table
7088
7089 @cindex range checking
7090 @cindex checks, range
7091 @node Range Checking
7092 @subsection An overview of range checking
7093
7094 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7095 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7096 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7097 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7098 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7099
7100 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7101 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7102 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7103 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7104
7105 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7106 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7107 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7108 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7109 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7110 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7111
7112 @smallexample
7113 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7114 @end smallexample
7115
7116 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7117 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7118 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7119
7120 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7121
7122 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7123 @kindex set check range
7124 @kindex show check range
7125 @table @code
7126 @item set check range auto
7127 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7128 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7129 each language.
7130
7131 @item set check range on
7132 @itemx set check range off
7133 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7134 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7135 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7136 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7137
7138 @item set check range warn
7139 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7140 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7141 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7142 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7143 systems).
7144
7145 @item show range
7146 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7147 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7148 @end table
7149
7150 @node Support
7151 @section Supported languages
7152
7153 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
7154 @c This is false ...
7155 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7156 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7157 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7158 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7159 language.
7160
7161 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7162 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7163 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7164 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7165 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7166 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7167 language reference or tutorial.
7168
7169 @menu
7170 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7171 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7172 * Chill:: Chill
7173 @end menu
7174
7175 @node C
7176 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7177
7178 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7179 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7180
7181 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7182 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7183 together.
7184
7185 @cindex C@t{++}
7186 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7187 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7188 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7189 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7190 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7191 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7192 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7193
7194 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
7195 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7196 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7197 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7198 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
7199
7200 @menu
7201 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7202 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7203 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7204 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7205 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7206 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7207 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7208 @end menu
7209
7210 @node C Operators
7211 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7212
7213 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7214
7215 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7216 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7217 often defined on groups of types.
7218
7219 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7220
7221 @itemize @bullet
7222
7223 @item
7224 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7225 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7226
7227 @item
7228 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7229 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7230
7231 @item
7232 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7233
7234 @item
7235 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7236
7237 @end itemize
7238
7239 @noindent
7240 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7241 in order of increasing precedence:
7242
7243 @table @code
7244 @item ,
7245 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7246 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7247 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7248
7249 @item =
7250 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7251 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7252
7253 @item @var{op}=
7254 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7255 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7256 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7257 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7258 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7259
7260 @item ?:
7261 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7262 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7263 integral type.
7264
7265 @item ||
7266 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7267
7268 @item &&
7269 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7270
7271 @item |
7272 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7273
7274 @item ^
7275 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7276
7277 @item &
7278 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7279
7280 @item ==@r{, }!=
7281 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7282 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7283
7284 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7285 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7286 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7287 and non-zero for true.
7288
7289 @item <<@r{, }>>
7290 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7291
7292 @item @@
7293 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7294
7295 @item +@r{, }-
7296 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7297 pointer types.
7298
7299 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7300 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7301 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7302 integral types.
7303
7304 @item ++@r{, }--
7305 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7306 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7307 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7308 operation takes place.
7309
7310 @item *
7311 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7312 @code{++}.
7313
7314 @item &
7315 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7316
7317 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7318 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
7319 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
7320 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
7321 stored.
7322
7323 @item -
7324 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7325 precedence as @code{++}.
7326
7327 @item !
7328 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7329 @code{++}.
7330
7331 @item ~
7332 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7333 @code{++}.
7334
7335
7336 @item .@r{, }->
7337 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7338 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7339 pointer based on the stored type information.
7340 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7341
7342 @item .*@r{, }->*
7343 Dereferences of pointers to members.
7344
7345 @item []
7346 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7347 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7348
7349 @item ()
7350 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7351
7352 @item ::
7353 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7354 and @code{class} types.
7355
7356 @item ::
7357 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7358 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7359 above.
7360 @end table
7361
7362 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7363 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7364 predefined meaning.
7365
7366 @menu
7367 * C Constants::
7368 @end menu
7369
7370 @node C Constants
7371 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
7372
7373 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
7374
7375 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
7376 following ways:
7377
7378 @itemize @bullet
7379 @item
7380 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
7381 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
7382 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
7383 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7384 @code{long} value.
7385
7386 @item
7387 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7388 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7389 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7390 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7391 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
7392 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7393 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7394 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7395 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7396 constant.
7397
7398 @item
7399 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7400 integral equivalents.
7401
7402 @item
7403 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7404 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
7405 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
7406 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7407 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7408 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7409 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7410 @samp{\n} for newline.
7411
7412 @item
7413 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7414 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7415 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7416 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7417 characters.
7418
7419 @item
7420 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7421 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7422
7423 @item
7424 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7425 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7426 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7427 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7428 @end itemize
7429
7430 @menu
7431 * C plus plus expressions::
7432 * C Defaults::
7433 * C Checks::
7434
7435 * Debugging C::
7436 @end menu
7437
7438 @node C plus plus expressions
7439 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
7440
7441 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
7442 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
7443
7444 @cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
7445 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
7446 @cindex C@t{++} and object formats
7447 @cindex object formats and C@t{++}
7448 @cindex a.out and C@t{++}
7449 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
7450 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
7451 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
7452 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
7453 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
7454 @c periodically whether this has happened...
7455 @quotation
7456 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
7457 proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
7458 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
7459 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
7460 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
7461 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
7462 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
7463 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
7464 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
7465 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
7466 @end quotation
7467
7468 @enumerate
7469
7470 @cindex member functions
7471 @item
7472 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
7473
7474 @smallexample
7475 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
7476 @end smallexample
7477
7478 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
7479 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
7480 @item
7481 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
7482 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
7483 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
7484 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
7485
7486 @cindex call overloaded functions
7487 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
7488 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
7489 @item
7490 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
7491 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
7492 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
7493 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
7494 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
7495 default arguments.
7496
7497 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7498 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7499 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7500 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7501 number of function arguments.
7502
7503 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7504 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
7505 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
7506
7507 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
7508 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7509 @smallexample
7510 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7511 @end smallexample
7512
7513 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
7514 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
7515
7516 @cindex reference declarations
7517 @item
7518 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7519 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
7520 dereferenced.
7521
7522 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7523 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7524 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7525 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7526 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7527
7528 @item
7529 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
7530 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7531 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7532 necessary, for example in an expression like
7533 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
7534 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
7535 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7536 @end enumerate
7537
7538 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
7539 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7540 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7541 invoking user-defined operators.
7542
7543 @node C Defaults
7544 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7545
7546 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
7547
7548 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7549 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
7550 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7551 selects the working language.
7552
7553 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7554 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7555 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
7556 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
7557 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7558 for further details.
7559
7560 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7561 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7562 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7563
7564 @node C Checks
7565 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7566
7567 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
7568
7569 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
7570 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7571 considers two variables type equivalent if:
7572
7573 @itemize @bullet
7574 @item
7575 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7576 enumerated tag.
7577
7578 @item
7579 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7580 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7581
7582 @ignore
7583 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7584 @c FIXME--beers?
7585 @item
7586 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7587 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7588 compilers.)
7589 @end ignore
7590 @end itemize
7591
7592 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7593 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7594 that is not itself an array.
7595
7596 @node Debugging C
7597 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
7598
7599 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7600 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7601 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7602 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
7603
7604 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7605 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7606 ,Expressions}.
7607
7608 @menu
7609 * Debugging C plus plus::
7610 @end menu
7611
7612 @node Debugging C plus plus
7613 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7614
7615 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
7616
7617 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7618 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
7619
7620 @table @code
7621 @cindex break in overloaded functions
7622 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
7623 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7624 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7625 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7626
7627 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
7628 @item rbreak @var{regex}
7629 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7630 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7631 classes.
7632 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7633
7634 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
7635 @item catch throw
7636 @itemx catch catch
7637 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
7638 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7639
7640 @cindex inheritance
7641 @item ptype @var{typename}
7642 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7643 @var{typename}.
7644 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7645
7646 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
7647 @item set print demangle
7648 @itemx show print demangle
7649 @itemx set print asm-demangle
7650 @itemx show print asm-demangle
7651 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7652 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
7653 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7654
7655 @item set print object
7656 @itemx show print object
7657 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7658 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7659
7660 @item set print vtbl
7661 @itemx show print vtbl
7662 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7663 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7664 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7665 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7666
7667 @kindex set overload-resolution
7668 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
7669 @item set overload-resolution on
7670 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
7671 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7672 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
7673 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
7674 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
7675 message.
7676
7677 @item set overload-resolution off
7678 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
7679 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7680 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7681 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7682 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7683 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7684 argument types.
7685
7686 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7687 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
7688 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
7689 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7690 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7691 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7692 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7693 @end table
7694
7695 @node Modula-2
7696 @subsection Modula-2
7697
7698 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
7699
7700 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7701 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7702 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7703 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7704 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7705 table.
7706
7707 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
7708 @menu
7709 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7710 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7711 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7712 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7713 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7714 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7715 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7716 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7717 @end menu
7718
7719 @node M2 Operators
7720 @subsubsection Operators
7721 @cindex Modula-2 operators
7722
7723 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7724 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7725 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7726 following definitions hold:
7727
7728 @itemize @bullet
7729
7730 @item
7731 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7732 their subranges.
7733
7734 @item
7735 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7736
7737 @item
7738 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7739
7740 @item
7741 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7742 @var{type}}.
7743
7744 @item
7745 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7746
7747 @item
7748 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7749
7750 @item
7751 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7752 @end itemize
7753
7754 @noindent
7755 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7756 increasing precedence:
7757
7758 @table @code
7759 @item ,
7760 Function argument or array index separator.
7761
7762 @item :=
7763 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7764 @var{value}.
7765
7766 @item <@r{, }>
7767 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7768 types.
7769
7770 @item <=@r{, }>=
7771 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
7772 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7773 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7774
7775 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7776 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7777 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7778 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7779 comment character.
7780
7781 @item IN
7782 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7783 Same precedence as @code{<}.
7784
7785 @item OR
7786 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7787
7788 @item AND@r{, }&
7789 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7790
7791 @item @@
7792 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7793
7794 @item +@r{, }-
7795 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7796 and difference on set types.
7797
7798 @item *
7799 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7800 on set types.
7801
7802 @item /
7803 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7804 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7805
7806 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
7807 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7808 precedence as @code{*}.
7809
7810 @item -
7811 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7812
7813 @item ^
7814 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7815
7816 @item NOT
7817 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7818 @code{^}.
7819
7820 @item .
7821 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7822 precedence as @code{^}.
7823
7824 @item []
7825 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7826
7827 @item ()
7828 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7829 as @code{^}.
7830
7831 @item ::@r{, }.
7832 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7833 @end table
7834
7835 @quotation
7836 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7837 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7838 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7839 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7840 @end quotation
7841
7842
7843 @node Built-In Func/Proc
7844 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
7845 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
7846
7847 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7848 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7849
7850 @table @var
7851
7852 @item a
7853 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7854
7855 @item c
7856 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7857
7858 @item i
7859 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7860
7861 @item m
7862 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7863 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7864 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7865
7866 @item n
7867 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7868
7869 @item r
7870 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7871
7872 @item t
7873 represents a type.
7874
7875 @item v
7876 represents a variable.
7877
7878 @item x
7879 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7880 explanation of the function for details.
7881 @end table
7882
7883 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7884
7885 @table @code
7886 @item ABS(@var{n})
7887 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7888
7889 @item CAP(@var{c})
7890 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
7891 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
7892
7893 @item CHR(@var{i})
7894 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7895
7896 @item DEC(@var{v})
7897 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
7898
7899 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7900 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7901 new value.
7902
7903 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7904 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7905 set.
7906
7907 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
7908 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7909
7910 @item HIGH(@var{a})
7911 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7912
7913 @item INC(@var{v})
7914 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
7915
7916 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7917 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7918 new value.
7919
7920 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7921 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7922 there. Returns the new set.
7923
7924 @item MAX(@var{t})
7925 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7926
7927 @item MIN(@var{t})
7928 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7929
7930 @item ODD(@var{i})
7931 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7932
7933 @item ORD(@var{x})
7934 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
7935 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7936 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
7937 integral, character and enumerated types.
7938
7939 @item SIZE(@var{x})
7940 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7941
7942 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
7943 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7944
7945 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7946 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7947 @end table
7948
7949 @quotation
7950 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7951 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7952 an error.
7953 @end quotation
7954
7955 @cindex Modula-2 constants
7956 @node M2 Constants
7957 @subsubsection Constants
7958
7959 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7960 ways:
7961
7962 @itemize @bullet
7963
7964 @item
7965 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7966 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7967 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7968 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7969
7970 @item
7971 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7972 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7973 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7974 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7975 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7976 digits.
7977
7978 @item
7979 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7980 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
7981 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
7982 followed by a @samp{C}.
7983
7984 @item
7985 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7986 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7987 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
7988 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
7989 sequences.
7990
7991 @item
7992 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7993
7994 @item
7995 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7996 @code{FALSE}.
7997
7998 @item
7999 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8000
8001 @item
8002 Set constants are not yet supported.
8003 @end itemize
8004
8005 @node M2 Defaults
8006 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8007 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8008
8009 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8010 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8011 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8012 selected the working language.
8013
8014 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8015 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8016 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8017 the language automatically}, for further details.
8018
8019 @node Deviations
8020 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8021 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8022
8023 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8024 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8025
8026 @itemize @bullet
8027 @item
8028 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8029 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8030 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8031 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8032 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8033 returned a pointer.)
8034
8035 @item
8036 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8037 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8038 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8039 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8040
8041 @item
8042 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8043 argument.
8044
8045 @item
8046 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8047 @end itemize
8048
8049 @node M2 Checks
8050 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8051 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8052
8053 @quotation
8054 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8055 range checking.
8056 @end quotation
8057 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8058
8059 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8060
8061 @itemize @bullet
8062 @item
8063 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8064 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8065
8066 @item
8067 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8068 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8069 @end itemize
8070
8071 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8072 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8073
8074 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8075 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8076
8077 @node M2 Scope
8078 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8079 @cindex scope
8080 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8081 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8082 @ifinfo
8083 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8084 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8085 @end ifinfo
8086 @iftex
8087 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8088 @end iftex
8089
8090 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8091 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8092 similar syntax:
8093
8094 @smallexample
8095
8096 @var{module} . @var{id}
8097 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8098 @end smallexample
8099
8100 @noindent
8101 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8102 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8103 identifier within your program, except another module.
8104
8105 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8106 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8107 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8108 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8109
8110 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8111 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8112 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8113 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8114 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8115 @var{module}.
8116
8117 @node GDB/M2
8118 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8119
8120 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8121 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8122 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8123 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8124 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8125 analogue in Modula-2.
8126
8127 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8128 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8129 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8130 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8131 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8132 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8133
8134 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8135 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8136 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8137
8138 @node Chill
8139 @subsection Chill
8140
8141 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
8142 from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
8143 supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8144 likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8145 table.
8146
8147 @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8148 @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8149 This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
8150 of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8151
8152 @menu
8153 * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8154 * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
8155 * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
8156 * Chill type and range checks::
8157 * Chill defaults::
8158 @end menu
8159
8160 @node How modes are displayed
8161 @subsubsection How modes are displayed
8162
8163 The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
8164 with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
8165 slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8166 provided modes are:
8167
8168 @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8169 @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
8170 @table @code
8171 @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8172 @itemize @bullet
8173 @item
8174 @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8175 UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8176 @item
8177 @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
8178 @item
8179 @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
8180 @item
8181 @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8182 @smallexample
8183 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8184 type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8185 @end smallexample
8186 If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8187 @item
8188 @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8189 @smallexample
8190 @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8191 @end smallexample
8192 where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8193 expression (e.g. set element names).
8194 @end itemize
8195
8196 @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8197 A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
8198 the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
8199 @smallexample
8200 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8201 type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8202 @end smallexample
8203
8204 @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8205 @itemize @bullet
8206 @item
8207 @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
8208 followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8209 @item
8210 @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8211 @end itemize
8212
8213 @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8214 The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8215 <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
8216 list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8217 the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
8218 all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8219
8220 @ignore
8221 @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8222 The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
8223 type, and is therefore not really of interest.
8224 @end ignore
8225
8226 @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
8227 @itemize @bullet
8228 @item
8229 @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8230 @smallexample
8231 @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8232 @end smallexample
8233 where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8234 @item
8235 @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8236 @smallexample
8237 @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8238 @end smallexample
8239 where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
8240 @end itemize
8241
8242 @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
8243 @itemize @bullet
8244 @item
8245 @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8246 @item
8247 @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8248 @end itemize
8249
8250 @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8251 Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8252
8253 @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8254 @itemize @bullet
8255 @item
8256 @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8257 @smallexample
8258 @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8259 @end smallexample
8260 followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8261 mode
8262 @item
8263 @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8264 @smallexample
8265 @code{BOOLS(<string
8266 length>)}
8267 @end smallexample
8268 @end itemize
8269
8270 @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8271 The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8272 followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8273 @smallexample
8274 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8275 type = ARRAY (1:42)
8276 ARRAY (1:20)
8277 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8278 @end smallexample
8279
8280 @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
8281 The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
8282 list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8283 of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8284 OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
8285 of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8286 checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8287 always displays all variant fields.
8288 @smallexample
8289 (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8290 type = STRUCT (
8291 as x,
8292 bs x,
8293 CASE bs OF
8294 (karli):
8295 cs a
8296 (ott):
8297 ds x
8298 ESAC
8299 )
8300 @end smallexample
8301 @end table
8302
8303 @node Locations
8304 @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8305
8306 A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8307
8308 A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
8309 the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8310 Chill programs. How values are specified
8311 is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
8312
8313 The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8314 display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
8315
8316 @smallexample
8317 set result := EXPR
8318 @end smallexample
8319
8320 @noindent
8321 This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
8322 is not available in @value{GDBN}).
8323
8324 Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8325 value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
8326 mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
8327 represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8328 value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
8329 operator @samp{->}.
8330
8331 Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8332 @smallexample
8333 @code{@{ PROC
8334 (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
8335 location>}
8336 @end smallexample
8337 @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8338 specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8339 the entry point.
8340
8341 @ignore
8342 Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8343 fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8344 the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
8345 implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8346 na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8347 <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
8348 @code{__proc_copy}.
8349
8350 Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8351 the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8352 like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8353 mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8354
8355 Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
8356 ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
8357 definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
8358 of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8359 structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8360 braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
8361 on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
8362 memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
8363 all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
8364 @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
8365 stuff ???)
8366 @smallexample
8367 (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8368 [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8369 @end smallexample
8370 @end ignore
8371
8372 Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8373 (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
8374 certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8375 and their Operations}.
8376
8377 A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
8378 location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8379 name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8380 have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8381 checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
8382 therefore the result can be quite confusing.
8383
8384 @smallexample
8385 (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8386 @end smallexample
8387
8388 @node Values and their Operations
8389 @subsubsection Values and their Operations
8390
8391 Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8392 more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
8393 data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8394 such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
8395 constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
8396 when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
8397 (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8398 the values behind these locations.
8399
8400 This section describes how values have to be specified and which
8401 operations are legal to be used with such values.
8402
8403 @table @code
8404 @item Literal Values
8405 Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8406 For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
8407 chapter 1.5.
8408 @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8409 @c be converted to a @ref.
8410
8411 @ignore
8412 @itemize @bullet
8413 @item
8414 @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8415 programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
8416 @item
8417 @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8418 @item
8419 @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8420 @code{'M'})
8421 @item
8422 @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
8423 mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
8424 comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
8425 @item
8426 @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
8427 emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
8428 procedure value or the empty instance value.
8429
8430 @item
8431 @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
8432 enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
8433 to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
8434 @item
8435 @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8436 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
8437 @item
8438 @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
8439 (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
8440 @end itemize
8441 @end ignore
8442
8443 @item Tuple Values
8444 A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
8445 name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
8446 unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
8447 @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
8448
8449 @itemize @bullet
8450 @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
8451 @item @emph{Array Tuple}
8452 @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
8453 Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
8454 same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
8455 @end itemize
8456
8457 @item String Element Value
8458 A string element value is specified by
8459 @smallexample
8460 @code{<string value>(<index>)}
8461 @end smallexample
8462 where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
8463 value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
8464 the string.
8465
8466 @item String Slice Value
8467 A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
8468 spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
8469 expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
8470 @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
8471 The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
8472 string.
8473
8474 @item Array Element Values
8475 An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
8476 delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
8477
8478 @item Array Slice Values
8479 An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
8480 @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
8481 @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
8482 arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
8483 which is part of the specified array.
8484
8485 @item Structure Field Values
8486 A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
8487 name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
8488 in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
8489 corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
8490
8491 @item Procedure Call Value
8492 The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
8493 procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
8494 expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
8495 effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
8496
8497 Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
8498
8499 Values of time mode locations appear as
8500 @smallexample
8501 @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8502 @end smallexample
8503
8504
8505 @ignore
8506 This is not implemented yet:
8507 @item Built-in Value
8508 @noindent
8509 The following built in functions are provided:
8510
8511 @table @code
8512 @item @code{ADDR()}
8513 @item @code{NUM()}
8514 @item @code{PRED()}
8515 @item @code{SUCC()}
8516 @item @code{ABS()}
8517 @item @code{CARD()}
8518 @item @code{MAX()}
8519 @item @code{MIN()}
8520 @item @code{SIZE()}
8521 @item @code{UPPER()}
8522 @item @code{LOWER()}
8523 @item @code{LENGTH()}
8524 @item @code{SIN()}
8525 @item @code{COS()}
8526 @item @code{TAN()}
8527 @item @code{ARCSIN()}
8528 @item @code{ARCCOS()}
8529 @item @code{ARCTAN()}
8530 @item @code{EXP()}
8531 @item @code{LN()}
8532 @item @code{LOG()}
8533 @item @code{SQRT()}
8534 @end table
8535
8536 For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8537 chapter 1.6.
8538 @end ignore
8539
8540 @item Zero-adic Operator Value
8541 The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8542 current active process.
8543
8544 @item Expression Values
8545 The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
8546 the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
8547 incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
8548 corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
8549 causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
8550 which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
8551 operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
8552
8553 @table @code
8554 @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
8555 @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8556 @itemx @code{NOT}
8557 Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
8558
8559 @item @code{=, /=}
8560 Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
8561
8562 @item @code{>, >=}
8563 @itemx @code{<, <=}
8564 Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
8565
8566 @item @code{+, -}
8567 @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
8568 Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
8569
8570 @item @code{-}
8571 Change sign operator.
8572
8573 @item @code{//}
8574 String concatenation operator.
8575
8576 @item @code{()}
8577 String repetition operator.
8578
8579 @item @code{->}
8580 Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8581 address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8582 location (@code{loc->}).
8583
8584 @item @code{OR, XOR}
8585 @itemx @code{AND}
8586 @itemx @code{NOT}
8587 Powerset and bitstring operators.
8588
8589 @item @code{>, >=}
8590 @itemx @code{<, <=}
8591 Powerset inclusion operators.
8592
8593 @item @code{IN}
8594 Membership operator.
8595 @end table
8596 @end table
8597
8598 @node Chill type and range checks
8599 @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8600
8601 @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
8602 of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
8603 complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
8604 equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
8605 structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8606
8607 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8608 index bounds and all built in procedures.
8609
8610 Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
8611 check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
8612 operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8613 functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8614 language specification.
8615
8616 All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8617 off}.
8618
8619 @ignore
8620 @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
8621 see last paragraph ?
8622 @end ignore
8623
8624 @node Chill defaults
8625 @subsubsection Chill defaults
8626
8627 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8628 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8629 Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8630 selected the working language.
8631
8632 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8633 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
8634 working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8635 the language automatically}, for further details.
8636
8637 @node Symbols
8638 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8639
8640 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8641 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8642 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8643 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8644 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8645 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8646 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8647
8648 @cindex symbol names
8649 @cindex names of symbols
8650 @cindex quoting names
8651 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8652 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8653 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8654 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8655 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8656 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8657 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8658 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8659
8660 @smallexample
8661 p 'foo.c'::x
8662 @end smallexample
8663
8664 @noindent
8665 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8666
8667 @table @code
8668 @kindex info address
8669 @cindex address of a symbol
8670 @item info address @var{symbol}
8671 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8672 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8673 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8674 is always stored.
8675
8676 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8677 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8678 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8679
8680 @kindex info symbol
8681 @cindex symbol from address
8682 @item info symbol @var{addr}
8683 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8684 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8685 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8686
8687 @smallexample
8688 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8689 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8690 @end smallexample
8691
8692 @noindent
8693 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8694 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8695
8696 @kindex whatis
8697 @item whatis @var{expr}
8698 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
8699 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8700 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8701 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8702
8703 @item whatis
8704 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8705
8706 @kindex ptype
8707 @item ptype @var{typename}
8708 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
8709 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8710 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8711 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8712
8713 @item ptype @var{expr}
8714 @itemx ptype
8715 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
8716 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8717 of just the name of the type.
8718
8719 For example, for this variable declaration:
8720
8721 @smallexample
8722 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8723 @end smallexample
8724
8725 @noindent
8726 the two commands give this output:
8727
8728 @smallexample
8729 @group
8730 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8731 type = struct complex
8732 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8733 type = struct complex @{
8734 double real;
8735 double imag;
8736 @}
8737 @end group
8738 @end smallexample
8739
8740 @noindent
8741 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8742 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8743
8744 @kindex info types
8745 @item info types @var{regexp}
8746 @itemx info types
8747 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
8748 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8749 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8750 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
8751 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
8752 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8753
8754 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8755 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8756 lists all source files where a type is defined.
8757
8758 @kindex info scope
8759 @cindex local variables
8760 @item info scope @var{addr}
8761 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8762 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8763 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8764 scope defined by that location. For example:
8765
8766 @smallexample
8767 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8768 Scope for command_line_handler:
8769 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8770 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8771 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8772 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8773 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8774 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8775 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8776 @end smallexample
8777
8778 @noindent
8779 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8780 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8781 collect}.
8782
8783 @kindex info source
8784 @item info source
8785 Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8786 the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8787 it was written in.
8788
8789 @kindex info sources
8790 @item info sources
8791 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8792 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8793 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8794
8795 @kindex info functions
8796 @item info functions
8797 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8798
8799 @item info functions @var{regexp}
8800 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8801 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8802 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8803 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8804 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8805 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8806 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
8807
8808 @kindex info variables
8809 @item info variables
8810 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8811 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
8812
8813 @item info variables @var{regexp}
8814 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8815 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8816 @var{regexp}.
8817
8818 @ignore
8819 This was never implemented.
8820 @kindex info methods
8821 @item info methods
8822 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8823 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
8824 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8825 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8826 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
8827 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8828 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8829 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8830 @end ignore
8831
8832 @cindex reloading symbols
8833 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
8834 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8835 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8836 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8837 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
8838
8839 @table @code
8840 @kindex set symbol-reloading
8841 @item set symbol-reloading on
8842 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8843 object file with a particular name is seen again.
8844
8845 @item set symbol-reloading off
8846 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8847 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8848 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8849 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8850 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8851 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8852 name.
8853
8854 @kindex show symbol-reloading
8855 @item show symbol-reloading
8856 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8857 @end table
8858
8859 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8860 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
8861 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8862 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8863 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8864 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8865 another source file. The default is on.
8866
8867 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8868 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8869
8870 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
8871 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8872 is printed as follows:
8873 @smallexample
8874 @{<no data fields>@}
8875 @end smallexample
8876
8877 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8878 @item show opaque-type-resolution
8879 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
8880
8881 @kindex maint print symbols
8882 @cindex symbol dump
8883 @kindex maint print psymbols
8884 @cindex partial symbol dump
8885 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8886 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8887 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8888 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8889 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8890 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8891 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8892 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8893 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8894 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8895 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8896 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8897 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8898 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8899 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8900 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8901 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8902 @end table
8903
8904 @node Altering
8905 @chapter Altering Execution
8906
8907 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8908 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8909 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8910 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8911 program.
8912
8913 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
8914 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8915 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
8916
8917 @menu
8918 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8919 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
8920 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
8921 * Returning:: Returning from a function
8922 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8923 * Patching:: Patching your program
8924 @end menu
8925
8926 @node Assignment
8927 @section Assignment to variables
8928
8929 @cindex assignment
8930 @cindex setting variables
8931 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8932 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8933
8934 @smallexample
8935 print x=4
8936 @end smallexample
8937
8938 @noindent
8939 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
8940 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
8941 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8942 information on operators in supported languages.
8943
8944 @kindex set variable
8945 @cindex variables, setting
8946 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8947 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8948 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8949 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8950 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8951
8952 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8953 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8954 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8955 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8956 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8957 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8958 command @code{set width}:
8959
8960 @smallexample
8961 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8962 type = double
8963 (@value{GDBP}) p width
8964 $4 = 13
8965 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8966 Invalid syntax in expression.
8967 @end smallexample
8968
8969 @noindent
8970 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8971 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8972
8973 @smallexample
8974 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8975 @end smallexample
8976
8977 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8978 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8979 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8980 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8981 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8982 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8983
8984 @smallexample
8985 @group
8986 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8987 type = double
8988 (@value{GDBP}) p g
8989 $1 = 1
8990 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
8991 (@value{GDBP}) p g
8992 $2 = 1
8993 (@value{GDBP}) r
8994 The program being debugged has been started already.
8995 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8996 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
8997 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8998 Invalid bfd target.
8999 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9000 The current BFD target is "=4".
9001 @end group
9002 @end smallexample
9003
9004 @noindent
9005 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9006 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9007 @code{g}, use
9008
9009 @smallexample
9010 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9011 @end smallexample
9012
9013 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9014 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9015 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9016 same length or shorter.
9017 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9018 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9019
9020 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9021 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9022 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9023 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9024 and representation in memory), and
9025
9026 @smallexample
9027 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9028 @end smallexample
9029
9030 @noindent
9031 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9032
9033 @node Jumping
9034 @section Continuing at a different address
9035
9036 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9037 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9038 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9039
9040 @table @code
9041 @kindex jump
9042 @item jump @var{linespec}
9043 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9044 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9045 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9046 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9047 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9048 breakpoints}.
9049
9050 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9051 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9052 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9053 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9054 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9055 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9056 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9057 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9058 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9059
9060 @item jump *@var{address}
9061 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9062 @end table
9063
9064 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9065 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9066 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9067 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9068 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9069 example,
9070
9071 @smallexample
9072 set $pc = 0x485
9073 @end smallexample
9074
9075 @noindent
9076 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9077 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9078 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9079
9080 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9081 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9082 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9083 detail.
9084
9085 @c @group
9086 @node Signaling
9087 @section Giving your program a signal
9088
9089 @table @code
9090 @kindex signal
9091 @item signal @var{signal}
9092 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9093 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9094 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9095 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9096
9097 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9098 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9099 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9100 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9101 signal.
9102
9103 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9104 after executing the command.
9105 @end table
9106 @c @end group
9107
9108 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9109 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9110 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9111 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9112 passes the signal directly to your program.
9113
9114
9115 @node Returning
9116 @section Returning from a function
9117
9118 @table @code
9119 @cindex returning from a function
9120 @kindex return
9121 @item return
9122 @itemx return @var{expression}
9123 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9124 command. If you give an
9125 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9126 value.
9127 @end table
9128
9129 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9130 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9131 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9132 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9133
9134 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9135 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9136 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9137 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9138 of functions.
9139
9140 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9141 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9142 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9143 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9144 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9145
9146 @node Calling
9147 @section Calling program functions
9148
9149 @cindex calling functions
9150 @kindex call
9151 @table @code
9152 @item call @var{expr}
9153 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9154 returned values.
9155 @end table
9156
9157 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9158 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9159 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9160 is printed and saved in the value history.
9161
9162 @c OBSOLETE For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
9163 @c OBSOLETE specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
9164 @c OBSOLETE calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
9165 @c OBSOLETE method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
9166 @c OBSOLETE that have separate instruction and data spaces.
9167
9168 @node Patching
9169 @section Patching programs
9170
9171 @cindex patching binaries
9172 @cindex writing into executables
9173 @cindex writing into corefiles
9174
9175 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9176 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9177 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9178 patching your program's binary.
9179
9180 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9181 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9182 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9183 repairs.
9184
9185 @table @code
9186 @kindex set write
9187 @item set write on
9188 @itemx set write off
9189 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9190 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9191 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9192
9193 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9194 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9195 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9196
9197 @item show write
9198 @kindex show write
9199 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9200 as well as reading.
9201 @end table
9202
9203 @node GDB Files
9204 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9205
9206 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9207 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9208 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9209 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9210
9211 @menu
9212 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9213 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9214 @end menu
9215
9216 @node Files
9217 @section Commands to specify files
9218
9219 @cindex symbol table
9220 @cindex core dump file
9221
9222 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9223 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9224 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9225 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9226
9227 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9228 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9229 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9230 to specify new files are useful.
9231
9232 @table @code
9233 @cindex executable file
9234 @kindex file
9235 @item file @var{filename}
9236 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9237 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9238 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9239 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9240 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9241 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9242 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9243 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9244
9245 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9246 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9247 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9248 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9249 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9250 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9251 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9252 for more information.
9253
9254 @item file
9255 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9256 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9257
9258 @kindex exec-file
9259 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9260 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9261 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9262 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9263 discard information on the executable file.
9264
9265 @kindex symbol-file
9266 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9267 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9268 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9269 table and program to run from the same file.
9270
9271 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9272 program's symbol table.
9273
9274 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9275 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9276 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9277 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9278 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9279
9280 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9281 executing it once.
9282
9283 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9284 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9285 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9286 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9287 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9288 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9289 optimized code.
9290
9291 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9292 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9293 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9294 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9295 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9296
9297 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9298 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9299 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9300 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9301 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9302 warnings and messages}.)
9303
9304 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9305 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9306 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9307 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9308 in stabs format.
9309
9310 @kindex readnow
9311 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9312 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9313 @kindex mapped
9314 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9315 @cindex saving symbol table
9316 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9317 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9318 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9319 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9320 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9321 entire symbol table available.
9322
9323 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9324 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9325 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9326 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9327 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9328 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9329 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9330 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9331
9332 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9333 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9334
9335 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9336 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9337 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9338 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9339 needed.
9340
9341 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9342 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9343 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9344
9345 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9346 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9347 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9348 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9349 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9350 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9351 @c files.
9352
9353 @kindex core
9354 @kindex core-file
9355 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9356 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9357 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9358 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9359 executable file itself for other parts.
9360
9361 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9362 to be used.
9363
9364 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9365 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9366 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9367 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9368 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9369
9370 @kindex add-symbol-file
9371 @cindex dynamic linking
9372 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9373 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9374 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9375 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9376 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9377 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9378 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9379 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9380 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9381 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9382 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9383 @var{address} as an expression.
9384
9385 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9386 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9387 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9388 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9389 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9390
9391 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9392 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9393 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9394 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9395 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9396 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9397 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9398 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9399 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9400
9401 @itemize @bullet
9402 @item
9403 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9404 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9405 @item
9406 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9407 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9408 @item
9409 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9410 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9411 @end itemize
9412
9413 @noindent
9414 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9415 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9416 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9417 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9418 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9419 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9420 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9421 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9422 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9423 way.
9424
9425 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9426
9427 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9428 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9429 table information for @var{filename}.
9430
9431 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9432 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9433 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9434 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9435 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9436 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9437
9438 @kindex section
9439 @item section
9440 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9441 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9442 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9443 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9444 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9445 the sections and their addresses.
9446
9447 @kindex info files
9448 @kindex info target
9449 @item info files
9450 @itemx info target
9451 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9452 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9453 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9454 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9455 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9456 current ones.
9457
9458 @kindex maint info sections
9459 @item maint info sections
9460 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9461 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9462 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9463 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9464 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9465 may be arbitrarily combined):
9466
9467 @table @code
9468 @item ALLOBJ
9469 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9470 @item @var{sections}
9471 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9472 @item @var{section-flags}
9473 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9474 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9475 @table @code
9476 @item ALLOC
9477 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9478 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9479 @item LOAD
9480 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9481 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9482 @item RELOC
9483 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9484 @item READONLY
9485 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9486 @item CODE
9487 Section contains executable code only.
9488 @item DATA
9489 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9490 @item ROM
9491 Section will reside in ROM.
9492 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9493 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9494 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9495 Section is not empty.
9496 @item NEVER_LOAD
9497 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9498 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9499 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9500 COFF shared library information.
9501 @item IS_COMMON
9502 Section contains common symbols.
9503 @end table
9504 @end table
9505 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9506 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9507 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9508 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9509 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9510 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9511 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9512 enhancement to debugging performance.
9513
9514 The default is off.
9515
9516 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9517 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9518 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9519 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9520 @end table
9521
9522 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9523 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9524 name and remembers it that way.
9525
9526 @cindex shared libraries
9527 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9528 libraries.
9529
9530 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9531 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9532 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9533 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9534 debugging a core file).
9535
9536 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9537 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9538
9539 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9540 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9541 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9542
9543 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9544 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9545 particularly large or there are many of them.
9546
9547 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9548 commands:
9549
9550 @table @code
9551 @kindex set auto-solib-add
9552 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9553 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9554 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9555 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9556 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9557 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9558 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9559
9560 @kindex show auto-solib-add
9561 @item show auto-solib-add
9562 Display the current autoloading mode.
9563 @end table
9564
9565 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9566 command:
9567
9568 @table @code
9569 @kindex info sharedlibrary
9570 @kindex info share
9571 @item info share
9572 @itemx info sharedlibrary
9573 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9574
9575 @kindex sharedlibrary
9576 @kindex share
9577 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9578 @itemx share @var{regex}
9579 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9580 Unix regular expression.
9581 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9582 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9583 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9584 loaded.
9585 @end table
9586
9587 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9588 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9589 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9590 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9591 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9592 wish.
9593
9594 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
9595 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9596 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
9597 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9598
9599 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9600
9601 @table @code
9602 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
9603 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9604 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9605 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9606 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9607 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
9608 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9609 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
9610 Mb).
9611
9612 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
9613 @item show auto-solib-limit
9614 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9615 @end table
9616
9617 @node Symbol Errors
9618 @section Errors reading symbol files
9619
9620 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9621 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9622 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9623 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9624 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9625 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9626 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9627 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9628 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9629 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9630 messages}).
9631
9632 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9633
9634 @table @code
9635 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9636
9637 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9638 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9639 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9640 in its outer scope blocks.
9641
9642 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9643 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9644 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9645 function.
9646
9647 @item block at @var{address} out of order
9648
9649 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9650 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9651 do so.
9652
9653 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9654 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9655 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9656 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9657 messages}.)
9658
9659 @item bad block start address patched
9660
9661 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9662 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9663 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9664
9665 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9666 starting on the previous source line.
9667
9668 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9669
9670 @cindex foo
9671 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9672 larger than the size of the string table.
9673
9674 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9675 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9676 with this name.
9677
9678 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9679
9680 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9681 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
9682 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
9683
9684 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9685 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
9686 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
9687 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9688 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9689 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
9690
9691 @item stub type has NULL name
9692
9693 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
9694
9695 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
9696 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
9697 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9698 it.
9699
9700 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9701
9702 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
9703
9704 @end table
9705
9706 @node Targets
9707 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
9708
9709 @cindex debugging target
9710 @kindex target
9711
9712 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
9713
9714 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9715 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9716 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
9717 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9718 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
9719 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9720 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9721 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
9722
9723 @menu
9724 * Active Targets:: Active targets
9725 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
9726 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9727 * Remote:: Remote debugging
9728 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
9729
9730 @end menu
9731
9732 @node Active Targets
9733 @section Active targets
9734
9735 @cindex stacking targets
9736 @cindex active targets
9737 @cindex multiple targets
9738
9739 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
9740 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9741 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9742 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9743 a core file.
9744
9745 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9746 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9747 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9748 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9749 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9750 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9751 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9752 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9753 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
9754
9755 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
9756 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9757 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9758 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9759 process target is active.
9760
9761 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9762 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
9763 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
9764 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9765 process}).
9766
9767 @node Target Commands
9768 @section Commands for managing targets
9769
9770 @table @code
9771 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
9772 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9773 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9774 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9775 protocol of the target machine.
9776
9777 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9778 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9779 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
9780
9781 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9782 after executing the command.
9783
9784 @kindex help target
9785 @item help target
9786 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9787 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9788 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9789
9790 @item help target @var{name}
9791 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9792 select it.
9793
9794 @kindex set gnutarget
9795 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
9796 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
9797 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
9798 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9799 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
9800 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9801
9802 @quotation
9803 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9804 you must know the actual BFD name.
9805 @end quotation
9806
9807 @noindent
9808 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
9809
9810 @kindex show gnutarget
9811 @item show gnutarget
9812 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9813 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9814 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9815 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9816 @end table
9817
9818 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9819 configuration):
9820
9821 @table @code
9822 @kindex target exec
9823 @item target exec @var{program}
9824 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9825 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9826
9827 @kindex target core
9828 @item target core @var{filename}
9829 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9830 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
9831
9832 @kindex target remote
9833 @item target remote @var{dev}
9834 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9835 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9836 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
9837 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
9838 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9839 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9840
9841 @kindex target sim
9842 @item target sim
9843 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
9844 In general,
9845 @smallexample
9846 target sim
9847 load
9848 run
9849 @end smallexample
9850 @noindent
9851 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
9852 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
9853 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9854 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9855 Processors}.
9856
9857 @end table
9858
9859 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
9860
9861 @table @code
9862
9863 @kindex target nrom
9864 @item target nrom @var{dev}
9865 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9866
9867 @end table
9868
9869 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
9870 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
9871
9872 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9873 once you've successfully established a connection.
9874
9875 @table @code
9876
9877 @kindex load @var{filename}
9878 @item load @var{filename}
9879 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9880 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9881 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9882 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9883 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9884 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9885
9886 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9887 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9888 target is @dots{}}''
9889
9890 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9891 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9892 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9893 specifies a fixed address.
9894 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9895
9896 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9897 @end table
9898
9899 @node Byte Order
9900 @section Choosing target byte order
9901
9902 @cindex choosing target byte order
9903 @cindex target byte order
9904
9905 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9906 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9907 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9908 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9909 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
9910 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
9911
9912 @table @code
9913 @kindex set endian big
9914 @item set endian big
9915 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9916
9917 @kindex set endian little
9918 @item set endian little
9919 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9920
9921 @kindex set endian auto
9922 @item set endian auto
9923 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9924 executable.
9925
9926 @item show endian
9927 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9928
9929 @end table
9930
9931 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9932 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9933 target system.
9934
9935 @node Remote
9936 @section Remote debugging
9937 @cindex remote debugging
9938
9939 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
9940 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9941 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
9942 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9943 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9944
9945 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9946 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
9947 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
9948 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9949 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9950 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9951
9952 Other remote targets may be available in your
9953 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
9954
9955 @node KOD
9956 @section Kernel Object Display
9957
9958 @cindex kernel object display
9959 @cindex kernel object
9960 @cindex KOD
9961
9962 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9963 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9964 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9965 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9966 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9967
9968 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9969 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9970
9971 @smallexample
9972 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
9973 @end smallexample
9974
9975 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9976 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9977 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9978 after the operating system:
9979
9980 @smallexample
9981 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9982 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9983 Object Description
9984 any Any and all objects
9985 @end smallexample
9986
9987 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9988 by the kernel.
9989
9990 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9991 is supported other than to try it.
9992
9993
9994 @node Remote Debugging
9995 @chapter Debugging remote programs
9996
9997 @menu
9998 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
9999 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10000 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10001 @end menu
10002
10003 @node Server
10004 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10005
10006 @kindex gdbserver
10007 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10008 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10009 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10010 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10011
10012 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10013 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10014 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10015 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10016 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10017 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10018 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10019 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10020 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10021 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10022 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10023 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10024 choice for debugging.
10025
10026 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10027 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10028 protocol.
10029
10030 @table @emph
10031 @item On the target machine,
10032 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10033 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10034 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10035 system does all the symbol handling.
10036
10037 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10038 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10039 syntax is:
10040
10041 @smallexample
10042 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10043 @end smallexample
10044
10045 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10046 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10047 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10048 @file{/dev/com1}:
10049
10050 @smallexample
10051 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10052 @end smallexample
10053
10054 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10055 with it.
10056
10057 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10058
10059 @smallexample
10060 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10061 @end smallexample
10062
10063 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10064 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10065 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10066 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10067 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10068 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10069 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10070 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10071 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10072 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10073 @code{target remote} command.
10074
10075 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10076 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10077
10078 @smallexample
10079 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10080 @end smallexample
10081
10082 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10083 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10084
10085 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10086 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10087 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10088 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10089 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10090 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10091 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10092 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10093 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10094 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10095
10096 @smallexample
10097 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10098 @end smallexample
10099
10100 @noindent
10101 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10102
10103 @smallexample
10104 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 @noindent
10108 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10109 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10110 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10111 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10112 @samp{Connection refused}.
10113 @end table
10114
10115 @node NetWare
10116 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10117
10118 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10119 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10120 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10121 @code{target remote}.
10122
10123 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10124 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10125
10126 @table @emph
10127 @item On the target machine,
10128 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10129 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10130 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10131 host system does all the symbol handling.
10132
10133 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10134 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10135 program. The syntax is:
10136
10137 @smallexample
10138 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10139 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10140 @end smallexample
10141
10142 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10143 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10144 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10145
10146 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10147 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10148 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10149
10150 @smallexample
10151 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10152 @end smallexample
10153
10154 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10155 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10156 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10157 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10158 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10159 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10160 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10161 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10162 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10163
10164 @smallexample
10165 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10166 @end smallexample
10167
10168 @noindent
10169 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10170 @end table
10171
10172 @node remote stub
10173 @section Implementing a remote stub
10174
10175 @cindex debugging stub, example
10176 @cindex remote stub, example
10177 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10178 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10179 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10180 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10181 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10182 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10183 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10184 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10185
10186 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10187 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10188 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10189 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10190 program, you need:
10191
10192 @enumerate
10193 @item
10194 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10195 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10196 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10197
10198 @item
10199 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10200 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10201
10202 @item
10203 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10204 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10205 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10206 documentation.
10207 @end enumerate
10208
10209 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10210 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10211 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10212
10213 @table @emph
10214 @item On the host,
10215 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10216 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10217 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10218
10219 @item On the target,
10220 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10221 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10222 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10223
10224 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10225 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10226 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10227 @end table
10228
10229 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10230 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10231 @sc{sparc} boards.
10232
10233 @cindex remote serial stub list
10234 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10235
10236 @table @code
10237
10238 @item i386-stub.c
10239 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10240 @cindex Intel
10241 @cindex i386
10242 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10243
10244 @item m68k-stub.c
10245 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10246 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10247 @cindex m680x0
10248 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10249
10250 @item sh-stub.c
10251 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10252 @cindex Hitachi
10253 @cindex SH
10254 For Hitachi SH architectures.
10255
10256 @item sparc-stub.c
10257 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10258 @cindex Sparc
10259 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10260
10261 @item sparcl-stub.c
10262 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10263 @cindex Fujitsu
10264 @cindex SparcLite
10265 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10266
10267 @end table
10268
10269 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10270 recently added stubs.
10271
10272 @menu
10273 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10274 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10275 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10276 @end menu
10277
10278 @node Stub Contents
10279 @subsection What the stub can do for you
10280
10281 @cindex remote serial stub
10282 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10283 subroutines:
10284
10285 @table @code
10286 @item set_debug_traps
10287 @kindex set_debug_traps
10288 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10289 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10290 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10291 beginning of your program.
10292
10293 @item handle_exception
10294 @kindex handle_exception
10295 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10296 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10297 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10298 run when a trap is triggered.
10299
10300 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10301 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10302 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10303 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
10304 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
10305 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10306 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10307 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10308 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
10309 machine.
10310
10311 @item breakpoint
10312 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10313 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10314 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10315 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10316 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10317 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10318 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10319 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10320 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10321 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
10322 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
10323
10324 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10325 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10326 start of your debugging session.
10327 @end table
10328
10329 @node Bootstrapping
10330 @subsection What you must do for the stub
10331
10332 @cindex remote stub, support routines
10333 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10334 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10335 debugging target machine.
10336
10337 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10338 serial port.
10339
10340 @table @code
10341 @item int getDebugChar()
10342 @kindex getDebugChar
10343 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10344 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10345 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10346
10347 @item void putDebugChar(int)
10348 @kindex putDebugChar
10349 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
10350 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
10351 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10352 @end table
10353
10354 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
10355 @cindex interrupting remote targets
10356 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10357 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10358 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10359 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10360 remote system to stop.
10361
10362 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10363 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10364 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10365 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10366
10367 Other routines you need to supply are:
10368
10369 @table @code
10370 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10371 @kindex exceptionHandler
10372 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10373 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10374 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10375 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10376 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10377 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10378 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10379 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10380 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10381 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10382 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10383 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10384 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10385
10386 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10387 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10388 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10389 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10390 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10391
10392 @item void flush_i_cache()
10393 @kindex flush_i_cache
10394 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
10395 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10396 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10397
10398 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10399 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10400 @end table
10401
10402 @noindent
10403 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10404
10405 @table @code
10406 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10407 @kindex memset
10408 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10409 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10410 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10411 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10412 @end table
10413
10414 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10415 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10416 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
10417 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
10418
10419
10420 @node Debug Session
10421 @subsection Putting it all together
10422
10423 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
10424 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10425 steps.
10426
10427 @enumerate
10428 @item
10429 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
10430 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10431 @display
10432 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10433 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10434 @end display
10435
10436 @item
10437 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10438
10439 @smallexample
10440 set_debug_traps();
10441 breakpoint();
10442 @end smallexample
10443
10444 @item
10445 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10446 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10447
10448 @smallexample
10449 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
10450 @end smallexample
10451
10452 @noindent
10453 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
10454 function in your program, that function is called when
10455 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10456 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10457 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10458
10459 @item
10460 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10461 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10462
10463 @item
10464 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10465 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10466
10467 @item
10468 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10469 @c document that. FIXME.
10470 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10471 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10472
10473 @item
10474 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10475 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10476 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10477 of its pure text.
10478
10479 @item
10480 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10481 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
10482 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10483 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
10484 TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
10485 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10486 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10487
10488 @smallexample
10489 target remote /dev/ttyb
10490 @end smallexample
10491
10492 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10493 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10494 @code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10495 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10496
10497 @smallexample
10498 target remote manyfarms:2828
10499 @end smallexample
10500
10501 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10502 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10503 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10504 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10505
10506 @smallexample
10507 target remote :1234
10508 @end smallexample
10509 @noindent
10510
10511 Note that the colon is still required here.
10512 @end enumerate
10513
10514 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10515 step and continue the remote program.
10516
10517 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10518 command.
10519
10520 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10521 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10522 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10523 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10524 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10525 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10526 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10527
10528 @smallexample
10529 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10530 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10531 @end smallexample
10532
10533 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10534 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10535 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10536 goes back to waiting.
10537
10538
10539 @node Configurations
10540 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10541
10542 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10543 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10544 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10545
10546 There are three major categories of configurations: native
10547 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10548 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10549 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10550 are quite different from each other.
10551
10552 @menu
10553 * Native::
10554 * Embedded OS::
10555 * Embedded Processors::
10556 * Architectures::
10557 @end menu
10558
10559 @node Native
10560 @section Native
10561
10562 This section describes details specific to particular native
10563 configurations.
10564
10565 @menu
10566 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
10567 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10568 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
10569 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
10570 @end menu
10571
10572 @node HP-UX
10573 @subsection HP-UX
10574
10575 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10576 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10577 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10578
10579 @node SVR4 Process Information
10580 @subsection SVR4 process information
10581
10582 @kindex /proc
10583 @cindex process image
10584
10585 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10586 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10587 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10588 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10589 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10590 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10591 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10592 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10593
10594 @table @code
10595 @kindex info proc
10596 @item info proc
10597 Summarize available information about the process.
10598
10599 @kindex info proc mappings
10600 @item info proc mappings
10601 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10602 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10603 @ignore
10604 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10605 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10606 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10607 @kindex info proc times
10608 @item info proc times
10609 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10610 its children.
10611
10612 @kindex info proc id
10613 @item info proc id
10614 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10615 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10616
10617 @kindex info proc status
10618 @item info proc status
10619 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10620 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10621 received.
10622
10623 @item info proc all
10624 Show all the above information about the process.
10625 @end ignore
10626 @end table
10627
10628 @node DJGPP Native
10629 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10630 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10631 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10632 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
10633
10634 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10635 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10636 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10637 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
10638
10639 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10640 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10641 subsection describes those commands.
10642
10643 @table @code
10644 @kindex info dos
10645 @item info dos
10646 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10647 information about the target system and important OS structures.
10648
10649 @kindex sysinfo
10650 @cindex MS-DOS system info
10651 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10652 @item info dos sysinfo
10653 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10654 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10655 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
10656
10657 @cindex GDT
10658 @cindex LDT
10659 @cindex IDT
10660 @cindex segment descriptor tables
10661 @cindex descriptor tables display
10662 @item info dos gdt
10663 @itemx info dos ldt
10664 @itemx info dos idt
10665 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10666 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10667 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10668 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10669 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10670 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10671 rights.
10672
10673 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10674 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10675 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10676 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10677 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
10678
10679 @cindex garbled pointers
10680 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10681 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10682 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10683 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10684 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10685 debugged program's data segment:
10686
10687 @smallexample
10688 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10689 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10690 @end smallexample
10691
10692 @noindent
10693 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10694 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
10695
10696 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10697 @item info dos pde
10698 @itemx info dos pte
10699 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10700 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10701 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10702 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10703 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10704 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10705 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10706 that is currently in use.
10707
10708 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10709 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10710 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10711 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10712 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10713 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10714 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
10715
10716 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10717 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10718 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10719 controller.
10720
10721 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
10722
10723 @cindex physical address from linear address
10724 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10725 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10726 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10727 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10728 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10729 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10730 the variable @code{i} is stored:
10731
10732 @smallexample
10733 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10734 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10735 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10736 @end smallexample
10737
10738 @noindent
10739 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10740 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10741 attributes of that page.
10742
10743 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10744 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10745 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10746 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10747 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10748 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
10749
10750 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10751 transfer buffer:
10752
10753 @smallexample
10754 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10755 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10756 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10757 @end smallexample
10758
10759 @noindent
10760 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
10761 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10762 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10763 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
10764
10765 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10766 @end table
10767
10768 @node Cygwin Native
10769 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
10770 @cindex MS Windows debugging
10771 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
10772 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
10773
10774 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, and
10775 defines a few commands specific to the Cygwin port. This
10776 subsection describes those commands.
10777
10778 @table @code
10779 @kindex info w32
10780 @item info w32
10781 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
10782 information about the target system and important OS structures.
10783
10784 @item info w32 selector
10785 This command displays information returned by
10786 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
10787 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
10788 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
10789 Without argument, this command displays information
10790 about the the six segment registers.
10791
10792 @kindex info dll
10793 @item info dll
10794 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
10795
10796 @kindex dll-symbols
10797 @item dll-symbols
10798 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
10799 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
10800
10801 @kindex set new-console
10802 @item set new-console @var{mode}
10803 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
10804 be started in a new console on next start.
10805 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
10806 be started in the same console as the debugger.
10807
10808 @kindex show new-console
10809 @item show new-console
10810 Displays whether a new console is used
10811 when the debuggee is started.
10812
10813 @kindex set new-group
10814 @item set new-group @var{mode}
10815 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
10816 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
10817 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
10818 Ctrl-C.
10819
10820 @kindex show new-group
10821 @item show new-group
10822 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
10823
10824 @kindex set debugevents
10825 @item set debugevents
10826 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
10827
10828 @kindex set debugexec
10829 @item set debugexec
10830 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
10831 seen by the debugger.
10832
10833 @kindex set debugexceptions
10834 @item set debugexceptions
10835 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
10836 seen by the debugger.
10837
10838 @kindex set debugmemory
10839 @item set debugmemory
10840 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
10841 seen by the debugger.
10842
10843 @kindex set shell
10844 @item set shell
10845 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
10846 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
10847
10848 @kindex show shell
10849 @item show shell
10850 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
10851
10852 @end table
10853
10854 @node Embedded OS
10855 @section Embedded Operating Systems
10856
10857 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10858 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10859 architectures.
10860
10861 @menu
10862 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10863 @end menu
10864
10865 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10866 various real-time operating systems.
10867
10868 @node VxWorks
10869 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10870
10871 @cindex VxWorks
10872
10873 @table @code
10874
10875 @kindex target vxworks
10876 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10877 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10878 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10879
10880 @end table
10881
10882 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10883 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10884
10885 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10886 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10887 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10888 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
10889 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
10890 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10891 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
10892
10893 @table @code
10894 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10895 @kindex vxworks-timeout
10896 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10897 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10898 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10899 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10900 of a thin network line.
10901 @end table
10902
10903 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10904 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10905 procedures.
10906
10907 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10908 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10909 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10910 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10911 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10912 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10913 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10914 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10915 manual.
10916 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10917
10918 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10919 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10920 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10921 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
10922
10923 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10924
10925 @smallexample
10926 (vxgdb)
10927 @end smallexample
10928
10929 @menu
10930 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10931 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10932 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10933 @end menu
10934
10935 @node VxWorks Connection
10936 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10937
10938 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10939 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10940
10941 @smallexample
10942 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10943 @end smallexample
10944
10945 @need 750
10946 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10947
10948 @smallexample
10949 Attaching remote machine across net...
10950 Connected to tt.
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 @need 1000
10954 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10955 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10956 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10957 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10958 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10959
10960 @smallexample
10961 prog.o: No such file or directory.
10962 @end smallexample
10963
10964 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10965 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10966 command again.
10967
10968 @node VxWorks Download
10969 @subsubsection VxWorks download
10970
10971 @cindex download to VxWorks
10972 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10973 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10974 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10975 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10976 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10977 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10978 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10979 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10980 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10981 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10982 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10983 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10984 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10985 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10986 program, type this on VxWorks:
10987
10988 @smallexample
10989 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10990 @end smallexample
10991
10992 @noindent
10993 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10994
10995 @smallexample
10996 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10997 (vxgdb) load prog.o
10998 @end smallexample
10999
11000 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11001
11002 @smallexample
11003 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11004 @end smallexample
11005
11006 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11007 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11008 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11009 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11010 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11011 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11012 table.)
11013
11014 @node VxWorks Attach
11015 @subsubsection Running tasks
11016
11017 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11018 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11019 follows:
11020
11021 @smallexample
11022 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11023 @end smallexample
11024
11025 @noindent
11026 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11027 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11028 the time of attachment.
11029
11030 @node Embedded Processors
11031 @section Embedded Processors
11032
11033 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11034 configurations.
11035
11036
11037 @c OBSOLETE * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
11038 @menu
11039 * ARM:: ARM
11040 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11041 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11042 * i960:: Intel i960
11043 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11044 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11045 * M88K:: Motorola M88K
11046 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11047 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11048 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11049 * SH:: Hitachi SH
11050 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11051 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11052 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11053 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11054 @end menu
11055
11056 @c OBSOLETE @node A29K Embedded
11057 @c OBSOLETE @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
11058 @c OBSOLETE
11059 @c OBSOLETE @menu
11060 @c OBSOLETE * A29K UDI::
11061 @c OBSOLETE * A29K EB29K::
11062 @c OBSOLETE * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
11063 @c OBSOLETE * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11064 @c OBSOLETE * Remote Log:: Remote log
11065 @c OBSOLETE @end menu
11066 @c OBSOLETE
11067 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
11068 @c OBSOLETE
11069 @c OBSOLETE @kindex target adapt
11070 @c OBSOLETE @item target adapt @var{dev}
11071 @c OBSOLETE Adapt monitor for A29K.
11072 @c OBSOLETE
11073 @c OBSOLETE @kindex target amd-eb
11074 @c OBSOLETE @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11075 @c OBSOLETE @cindex AMD EB29K
11076 @c OBSOLETE Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11077 @c OBSOLETE @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11078 @c OBSOLETE @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11079 @c OBSOLETE name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11080 @c OBSOLETE @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11081 @c OBSOLETE
11082 @c OBSOLETE @end table
11083 @c OBSOLETE
11084 @c OBSOLETE @node A29K UDI
11085 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection A29K UDI
11086 @c OBSOLETE
11087 @c OBSOLETE @cindex UDI
11088 @c OBSOLETE @cindex AMD29K via UDI
11089 @c OBSOLETE
11090 @c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11091 @c OBSOLETE protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11092 @c OBSOLETE configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11093 @c OBSOLETE program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11094 @c OBSOLETE use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11095 @c OBSOLETE @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11096 @c OBSOLETE
11097 @c OBSOLETE @table @code
11098 @c OBSOLETE @item target udi @var{keyword}
11099 @c OBSOLETE @kindex udi
11100 @c OBSOLETE Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11101 @c OBSOLETE @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11102 @c OBSOLETE This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11103 @c OBSOLETE connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11104 @c OBSOLETE working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11105 @c OBSOLETE to its pathname.
11106 @c OBSOLETE @end table
11107 @c OBSOLETE
11108 @c OBSOLETE @node A29K EB29K
11109 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11110 @c OBSOLETE
11111 @c OBSOLETE @cindex EB29K board
11112 @c OBSOLETE @cindex running 29K programs
11113 @c OBSOLETE
11114 @c OBSOLETE AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11115 @c OBSOLETE with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11116 @c OBSOLETE term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11117 @c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11118 @c OBSOLETE must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11119 @c OBSOLETE board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11120 @c OBSOLETE assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11121 @c OBSOLETE @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11122 @c OBSOLETE
11123 @c OBSOLETE @node Comms (EB29K)
11124 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Communications setup
11125 @c OBSOLETE
11126 @c OBSOLETE The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11127 @c OBSOLETE in DOS on the PC:
11128 @c OBSOLETE
11129 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
11130 @c OBSOLETE C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11131 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
11132 @c OBSOLETE
11133 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
11134 @c OBSOLETE This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11135 @c OBSOLETE bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11136 @c OBSOLETE you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11137 @c OBSOLETE end of the connection as well.
11138 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
11139 @c OBSOLETE @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11140 @c OBSOLETE @c
11141 @c OBSOLETE @c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11142 @c OBSOLETE @c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11143 @c OBSOLETE @c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11144 @c OBSOLETE @c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11145 @c OBSOLETE @c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
11146 @c OBSOLETE
11147 @c OBSOLETE To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11148 @c OBSOLETE the following at the DOS console:
11149 @c OBSOLETE
11150 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
11151 @c OBSOLETE C:\> CTTY com1
11152 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
11153 @c OBSOLETE
11154 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
11155 @c OBSOLETE (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11156 @c OBSOLETE the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
11157 @c OBSOLETE had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
11158 @c OBSOLETE
11159 @c OBSOLETE From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11160 @c OBSOLETE @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11161 @c OBSOLETE
11162 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
11163 @c OBSOLETE cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11164 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
11165 @c OBSOLETE
11166 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
11167 @c OBSOLETE The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11168 @c OBSOLETE serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11169 @c OBSOLETE may look something like the following:
11170 @c OBSOLETE
11171 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
11172 @c OBSOLETE tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11173 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
11174 @c OBSOLETE
11175 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
11176 @c OBSOLETE Your system may require a different name where we show
11177 @c OBSOLETE @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11178 @c OBSOLETE parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11179 @c OBSOLETE @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11180 @c OBSOLETE system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11181 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11182 @c OBSOLETE @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11183 @c OBSOLETE @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11184 @c OBSOLETE @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11185 @c OBSOLETE @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11186 @c OBSOLETE @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11187 @c OBSOLETE @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11188 @c OBSOLETE @c
11189 @c OBSOLETE @c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11190 @c OBSOLETE @c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11191 @c OBSOLETE @c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
11192 @c OBSOLETE
11193 @c OBSOLETE @kindex EBMON
11194 @c OBSOLETE Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11195 @c OBSOLETE directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11196 @c OBSOLETE start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11197 @c OBSOLETE with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11198 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11199 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11200 @c OBSOLETE
11201 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
11202 @c OBSOLETE C:\> G:
11203 @c OBSOLETE
11204 @c OBSOLETE G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11205 @c OBSOLETE
11206 @c OBSOLETE G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11207 @c OBSOLETE Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11208 @c OBSOLETE Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11209 @c OBSOLETE Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11210 @c OBSOLETE
11211 @c OBSOLETE Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11212 @c OBSOLETE
11213 @c OBSOLETE PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11214 @c OBSOLETE I/O Base = 0x208
11215 @c OBSOLETE Memory Base = 0xd0000
11216 @c OBSOLETE
11217 @c OBSOLETE Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11218 @c OBSOLETE Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11219 @c OBSOLETE Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11220 @c OBSOLETE
11221 @c OBSOLETE PageSize = 0x400
11222 @c OBSOLETE Register Stack Size = 0x800
11223 @c OBSOLETE Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11224 @c OBSOLETE
11225 @c OBSOLETE CPU PRL = 0x3
11226 @c OBSOLETE Am29027 Available = No
11227 @c OBSOLETE Byte Write Available = Yes
11228 @c OBSOLETE
11229 @c OBSOLETE # ~.
11230 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
11231 @c OBSOLETE
11232 @c OBSOLETE Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11233 @c OBSOLETE typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11234 @c OBSOLETE running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11235 @c OBSOLETE
11236 @c OBSOLETE For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11237 @c OBSOLETE way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
11238 @c OBSOLETE system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
11239 @c OBSOLETE PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11240 @c OBSOLETE something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11241 @c OBSOLETE other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11242 @c OBSOLETE from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11243 @c OBSOLETE serial line.
11244 @c OBSOLETE
11245 @c OBSOLETE @node gdb-EB29K
11246 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11247 @c OBSOLETE
11248 @c OBSOLETE Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11249 @c OBSOLETE program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11250 @c OBSOLETE name of your 29K program:
11251 @c OBSOLETE
11252 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
11253 @c OBSOLETE cd /usr/joe/work29k
11254 @c OBSOLETE @value{GDBP} myfoo
11255 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
11256 @c OBSOLETE
11257 @c OBSOLETE @need 500
11258 @c OBSOLETE Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11259 @c OBSOLETE
11260 @c OBSOLETE @smallexample
11261 @c OBSOLETE target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11262 @c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11263 @c OBSOLETE @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11264 @c OBSOLETE @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11265 @c OBSOLETE @end smallexample
11266 @c OBSOLETE
11267 @c OBSOLETE @noindent
11268 @c OBSOLETE In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11269 @c OBSOLETE @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11270 @c OBSOLETE @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11271 @c OBSOLETE In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11272 @c OBSOLETE a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11273 @c OBSOLETE the name on the Unix side.
11274 @c OBSOLETE
11275 @c OBSOLETE At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11276 @c OBSOLETE to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11277 @c OBSOLETE @code{run}.
11278 @c OBSOLETE
11279 @c OBSOLETE To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11280 @c OBSOLETE command.
11281 @c OBSOLETE
11282 @c OBSOLETE To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11283 @c OBSOLETE once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11284 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11285 @c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
11286 @c OBSOLETE Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
11287 @c OBSOLETE and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11288 @c OBSOLETE
11289 @c OBSOLETE @node Remote Log
11290 @c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Remote log
11291 @c OBSOLETE @cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
11292 @c OBSOLETE @cindex log file for EB29K
11293 @c OBSOLETE
11294 @c OBSOLETE The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11295 @c OBSOLETE current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11296 @c OBSOLETE @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11297 @c OBSOLETE of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11298 @c OBSOLETE another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11299 @c OBSOLETE unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11300
11301 @node ARM
11302 @subsection ARM
11303
11304 @table @code
11305
11306 @kindex target rdi
11307 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11308 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11309 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11310 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11311
11312 @kindex target rdp
11313 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11314 ARM Demon monitor.
11315
11316 @end table
11317
11318 @node H8/300
11319 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11320
11321 @table @code
11322
11323 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11324 @item target hms @var{dev}
11325 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11326 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11327 line and the communications speed used.
11328
11329 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11330 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11331 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11332
11333 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11334 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11335 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11336 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11337 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11338
11339 @end table
11340
11341 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11342 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11343 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11344 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11345 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11346 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11347 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11348 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11349
11350 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11351 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11352
11353 @enumerate
11354 @item
11355 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11356 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11357 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11358 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11359 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11360
11361 @item
11362 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11363 serial device available on your host is the default).
11364
11365 @item
11366 what speed to use over the serial device.
11367 @end enumerate
11368
11369 @menu
11370 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11371 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11372 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11373 @end menu
11374
11375 @node Hitachi Boards
11376 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11377
11378 @c only for Unix hosts
11379 @kindex device
11380 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11381 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11382 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11383 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11384 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11385
11386 @kindex speed
11387 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11388 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11389 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11390 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11391 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11392 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11393
11394 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11395 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11396 use a DOS host,
11397 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11398 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11399 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11400 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11401
11402 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11403 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11404 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11405 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11406
11407 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11408 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11409 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11410 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11411 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11412 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11413 @code{COM2}.
11414
11415 @smallexample
11416 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11417 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11418
11419 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11420
11421 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11422
11423 @end smallexample
11424
11425 @quotation
11426 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11427 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11428 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11429 your development board.
11430 @end quotation
11431
11432 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11433 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11434 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11435 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11436 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11437 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11438 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11439 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11440 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11441 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11442 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11443 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11444 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11445
11446 @smallexample
11447 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11448 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11449 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11450 the conditions.
11451 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11452 for details.
11453 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11454 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11455 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11456 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11457 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11458 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11459 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11460 @end smallexample
11461
11462 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11463 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11464 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11465 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11466 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11467 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11468
11469 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11470 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11471 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11472
11473 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11474 @itemize @bullet
11475 @item
11476 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11477 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11478
11479 @item
11480 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11481 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11482 to detect program completion.
11483 @end itemize
11484
11485 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11486 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11487
11488 @node Hitachi ICE
11489 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11490
11491 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11492 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11493 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11494 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11495
11496 @table @code
11497 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11498 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11499 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11500 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11501 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11502
11503 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11504 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11505 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11506 @end table
11507
11508 @node Hitachi Special
11509 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11510
11511 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11512
11513 @table @code
11514
11515 @kindex set machine
11516 @kindex show machine
11517 @item set machine h8300
11518 @itemx set machine h8300h
11519 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11520 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11521 to check which variant is currently in effect.
11522
11523 @end table
11524
11525 @node H8/500
11526 @subsection H8/500
11527
11528 @table @code
11529
11530 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
11531 @cindex memory models, H8/500
11532 @item set memory @var{mod}
11533 @itemx show memory
11534 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11535 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11536 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11537 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11538
11539 @end table
11540
11541 @node i960
11542 @subsection Intel i960
11543
11544 @table @code
11545
11546 @kindex target mon960
11547 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
11548 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11549
11550 @kindex target nindy
11551 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
11552 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11553 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11554 @file{/dev/ttya}.
11555
11556 @end table
11557
11558 @cindex Nindy
11559 @cindex i960
11560 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11561 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11562 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11563
11564 @itemize @bullet
11565 @item
11566 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11567 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11568
11569 @item
11570 By responding to a prompt on startup;
11571
11572 @item
11573 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11574 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11575
11576 @end itemize
11577
11578 @cindex download to Nindy-960
11579 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11580 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11581 @value{GDBN}.
11582
11583 @menu
11584 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11585 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11586 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11587 @end menu
11588
11589 @node Nindy Startup
11590 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11591
11592 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11593 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11594 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11595
11596 @smallexample
11597 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
11598 @end smallexample
11599
11600 @noindent
11601 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11602 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11603 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11604 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11605 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11606
11607 @node Nindy Options
11608 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
11609
11610 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11611 Nindy-960 board attached:
11612
11613 @table @code
11614 @item -r @var{port}
11615 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11616 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11617 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11618 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11619 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11620 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11621
11622 @item -O
11623 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11624 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11625 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11626 target architecture.
11627
11628 @quotation
11629 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11630 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11631 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11632 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11633 this process with an interrupt.
11634 @end quotation
11635
11636 @item -brk
11637 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11638 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11639
11640 @quotation
11641 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11642 requires; it only works with a few boards.
11643 @end quotation
11644 @end table
11645
11646 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11647 port.
11648
11649 @c @group
11650 @node Nindy Reset
11651 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
11652
11653 @table @code
11654 @item reset
11655 @kindex reset
11656 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11657 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11658 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11659 a break is detected.
11660 @end table
11661 @c @end group
11662
11663 @node M32R/D
11664 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11665
11666 @table @code
11667
11668 @kindex target m32r
11669 @item target m32r @var{dev}
11670 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11671
11672 @end table
11673
11674 @node M68K
11675 @subsection M68k
11676
11677 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11678 target command for the following ROM monitors.
11679
11680 @table @code
11681
11682 @kindex target abug
11683 @item target abug @var{dev}
11684 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11685
11686 @kindex target cpu32bug
11687 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11688 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11689
11690 @kindex target dbug
11691 @item target dbug @var{dev}
11692 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11693
11694 @kindex target est
11695 @item target est @var{dev}
11696 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11697
11698 @kindex target rom68k
11699 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
11700 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11701
11702 @end table
11703
11704 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11705 instead have only a single special target command:
11706
11707 @table @code
11708
11709 @kindex target es1800
11710 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
11711 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11712
11713 @end table
11714
11715 [context?]
11716
11717 @table @code
11718
11719 @kindex target rombug
11720 @item target rombug @var{dev}
11721 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11722
11723 @end table
11724
11725 @node M88K
11726 @subsection M88K
11727
11728 @table @code
11729
11730 @kindex target bug
11731 @item target bug @var{dev}
11732 BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11733
11734 @end table
11735
11736 @node MIPS Embedded
11737 @subsection MIPS Embedded
11738
11739 @cindex MIPS boards
11740 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11741 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11742 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11743
11744 @need 1000
11745 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11746
11747 @table @code
11748 @item target mips @var{port}
11749 @kindex target mips @var{port}
11750 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11751 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11752 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11753 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11754 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11755 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11756
11757 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11758 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11759 debugger:
11760
11761 @smallexample
11762 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11763 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11764 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11765 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11766 (@value{GDBP}) run
11767 @end smallexample
11768
11769 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11770 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11771 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11772 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11773 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11774
11775 @item target pmon @var{port}
11776 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
11777 PMON ROM monitor.
11778
11779 @item target ddb @var{port}
11780 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
11781 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11782
11783 @item target lsi @var{port}
11784 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
11785 LSI variant of PMON.
11786
11787 @kindex target r3900
11788 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
11789 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11790
11791 @kindex target array
11792 @item target array @var{dev}
11793 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11794
11795 @end table
11796
11797
11798 @noindent
11799 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11800
11801 @table @code
11802 @item set processor @var{args}
11803 @itemx show processor
11804 @kindex set processor @var{args}
11805 @kindex show processor
11806 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11807 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11808 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11809 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11810 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11811 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11812 @value{GDBN} is using.
11813
11814 @item set mipsfpu double
11815 @itemx set mipsfpu single
11816 @itemx set mipsfpu none
11817 @itemx show mipsfpu
11818 @kindex set mipsfpu
11819 @kindex show mipsfpu
11820 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
11821 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11822 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11823 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11824 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11825 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11826 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11827 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11828 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11829 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11830 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11831 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11832 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11833
11834 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11835 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11836 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11837
11838 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11839 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
11840
11841 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
11842 @itemx show remotedebug
11843 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11844 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11845 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11846 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11847 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11848 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11849 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11850 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11851 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11852 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11853 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11854
11855 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
11856 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11857 @itemx show timeout
11858 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
11859 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11860 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11861 @kindex set timeout
11862 @kindex show timeout
11863 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
11864 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
11865 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11866 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11867 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11868 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11869 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11870 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11871 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11872 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11873
11874 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11875 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11876 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11877 to run before stopping.
11878 @end table
11879
11880 @node PowerPC
11881 @subsection PowerPC
11882
11883 @table @code
11884
11885 @kindex target dink32
11886 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
11887 DINK32 ROM monitor.
11888
11889 @kindex target ppcbug
11890 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11891 @kindex target ppcbug1
11892 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11893 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11894
11895 @kindex target sds
11896 @item target sds @var{dev}
11897 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11898
11899 @end table
11900
11901 @node PA
11902 @subsection HP PA Embedded
11903
11904 @table @code
11905
11906 @kindex target op50n
11907 @item target op50n @var{dev}
11908 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11909
11910 @kindex target w89k
11911 @item target w89k @var{dev}
11912 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11913
11914 @end table
11915
11916 @node SH
11917 @subsection Hitachi SH
11918
11919 @table @code
11920
11921 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11922 @item target hms @var{dev}
11923 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11924 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11925 the communications speed used.
11926
11927 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11928 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11929 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11930
11931 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11932 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11933 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11934 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
11935 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11936
11937 @end table
11938
11939 @node Sparclet
11940 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11941
11942 @cindex Sparclet
11943
11944 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11945 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11946 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11947 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11948 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11949
11950 @table @code
11951 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
11952 @kindex remotetimeout
11953 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11954 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11955 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11956 @end table
11957
11958 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11959 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11960 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11961 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11962 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
11963
11964 @smallexample
11965 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11966 @end smallexample
11967
11968 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11969
11970 @smallexample
11971 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11972 @end smallexample
11973
11974 @cindex running, on Sparclet
11975 Once you have set
11976 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11977 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11978 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11979
11980 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11981
11982 @smallexample
11983 (gdbslet)
11984 @end smallexample
11985
11986 @menu
11987 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11988 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11989 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11990 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
11991 @end menu
11992
11993 @node Sparclet File
11994 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
11995
11996 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11997
11998 @smallexample
11999 (gdbslet) file prog
12000 @end smallexample
12001
12002 @need 1000
12003 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12004 @value{GDBN} locates
12005 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12006 path.
12007 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12008 files will be searched as well.
12009 @value{GDBN} locates
12010 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12011 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12012 If it fails
12013 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12014
12015 @smallexample
12016 prog: No such file or directory.
12017 @end smallexample
12018
12019 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12020 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12021 @code{target} command again.
12022
12023 @node Sparclet Connection
12024 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12025
12026 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12027 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12028
12029 @smallexample
12030 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12031 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12032 main () at ../prog.c:3
12033 @end smallexample
12034
12035 @need 750
12036 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12037
12038 @smallexample
12039 Connected to ttya.
12040 @end smallexample
12041
12042 @node Sparclet Download
12043 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12044
12045 @cindex download to Sparclet
12046 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12047 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12048 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12049 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12050 command.
12051 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12052 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12053 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12054 of each of the file's sections.
12055 For instance, if the program
12056 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12057 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12058
12059 @smallexample
12060 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12061 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12062 @end smallexample
12063
12064 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12065 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12066 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12067
12068 @node Sparclet Execution
12069 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12070
12071 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12072 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12073 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12074 manual for the list of commands.
12075
12076 @smallexample
12077 (gdbslet) b main
12078 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12079 (gdbslet) run
12080 Starting program: prog
12081 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12082 3 char *symarg = 0;
12083 (gdbslet) step
12084 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12085 (gdbslet)
12086 @end smallexample
12087
12088 @node Sparclite
12089 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12090
12091 @table @code
12092
12093 @kindex target sparclite
12094 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12095 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12096 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12097 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12098 remote protocol.
12099
12100 @end table
12101
12102 @node ST2000
12103 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12104
12105 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12106 STDBUG protocol.
12107
12108 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12109 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12110
12111 @smallexample
12112 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12113 @end smallexample
12114
12115 @noindent
12116 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12117 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12118 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12119 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12120 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12121
12122 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12123 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12124 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12125 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12126 available on your host computer.
12127 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12128 @c basically hearsay.
12129
12130 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12131 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12132 environment:
12133
12134 @table @code
12135 @item st2000 @var{command}
12136 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12137 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12138 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12139 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12140 manual for available commands.
12141
12142 @item connect
12143 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12144 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12145 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12146 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12147 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12148 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12149 @end table
12150
12151 @node Z8000
12152 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12153
12154 @cindex Z8000
12155 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12156 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12157
12158 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12159 a Z8000 simulator.
12160
12161 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12162 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12163 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12164 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12165
12166 @table @code
12167 @item target sim @var{args}
12168 @kindex sim
12169 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12170 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12171 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12172 @end table
12173
12174 @noindent
12175 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12176 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12177 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12178 to run your program, and so on.
12179
12180 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12181 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12182 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12183
12184 @table @code
12185
12186 @item cycles
12187 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12188
12189 @item insts
12190 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12191
12192 @item time
12193 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12194
12195 @end table
12196
12197 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12198 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12199 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12200 simulated clock ticks.
12201
12202 @node Architectures
12203 @section Architectures
12204
12205 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12206 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12207
12208 @menu
12209 * A29K::
12210 * Alpha::
12211 * MIPS::
12212 @end menu
12213
12214 @node A29K
12215 @subsection A29K
12216
12217 @table @code
12218
12219 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12220 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12221 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12222 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12223 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12224 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12225 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12226 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12227 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12228 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12229 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12230 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12231 hexadecimal.
12232
12233 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12234 @item show rstack_high_address
12235 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12236 processors.
12237
12238 @end table
12239
12240 @node Alpha
12241 @subsection Alpha
12242
12243 See the following section.
12244
12245 @node MIPS
12246 @subsection MIPS
12247
12248 @cindex stack on Alpha
12249 @cindex stack on MIPS
12250 @cindex Alpha stack
12251 @cindex MIPS stack
12252 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12253 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12254 find the beginning of a function.
12255
12256 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12257 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12258 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12259 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12260 commands:
12261
12262 @table @code
12263 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12264 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12265 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12266 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12267 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12268 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12269 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12270
12271 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12272 Display the current limit.
12273 @end table
12274
12275 @noindent
12276 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12277 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12278
12279
12280 @node Controlling GDB
12281 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12282
12283 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12284 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12285 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12286 described here.
12287
12288 @menu
12289 * Prompt:: Prompt
12290 * Editing:: Command editing
12291 * History:: Command history
12292 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12293 * Numbers:: Numbers
12294 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12295 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12296 @end menu
12297
12298 @node Prompt
12299 @section Prompt
12300
12301 @cindex prompt
12302
12303 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12304 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12305 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12306 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12307 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12308 which one you are talking to.
12309
12310 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12311 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12312 or a prompt that does not.
12313
12314 @table @code
12315 @kindex set prompt
12316 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12317 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12318
12319 @kindex show prompt
12320 @item show prompt
12321 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12322 @end table
12323
12324 @node Editing
12325 @section Command editing
12326 @cindex readline
12327 @cindex command line editing
12328
12329 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12330 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12331 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12332 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12333 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12334 debugging sessions.
12335
12336 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12337 command @code{set}.
12338
12339 @table @code
12340 @kindex set editing
12341 @cindex editing
12342 @item set editing
12343 @itemx set editing on
12344 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12345
12346 @item set editing off
12347 Disable command line editing.
12348
12349 @kindex show editing
12350 @item show editing
12351 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12352 @end table
12353
12354 @node History
12355 @section Command history
12356
12357 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12358 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12359 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12360 history facility.
12361
12362 @table @code
12363 @cindex history substitution
12364 @cindex history file
12365 @kindex set history filename
12366 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12367 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12368 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12369 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12370 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12371 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12372 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12373 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12374 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12375 is not set.
12376
12377 @cindex history save
12378 @kindex set history save
12379 @item set history save
12380 @itemx set history save on
12381 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12382 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12383
12384 @item set history save off
12385 Stop recording command history in a file.
12386
12387 @cindex history size
12388 @kindex set history size
12389 @item set history size @var{size}
12390 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12391 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12392 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12393 @end table
12394
12395 @cindex history expansion
12396 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12397 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12398 @xref{Event Designators}.
12399 @end ifset
12400
12401 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12402 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12403 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12404 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12405 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12406 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12407 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12408
12409 The commands to control history expansion are:
12410
12411 @table @code
12412 @kindex set history expansion
12413 @item set history expansion on
12414 @itemx set history expansion
12415 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12416
12417 @item set history expansion off
12418 Disable history expansion.
12419
12420 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12421 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12422 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12423 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12424 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12425 @end ifset
12426
12427 @c @group
12428 @kindex show history
12429 @item show history
12430 @itemx show history filename
12431 @itemx show history save
12432 @itemx show history size
12433 @itemx show history expansion
12434 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12435 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12436 @c @end group
12437 @end table
12438
12439 @table @code
12440 @kindex shows
12441 @item show commands
12442 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12443
12444 @item show commands @var{n}
12445 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12446
12447 @item show commands +
12448 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12449 @end table
12450
12451 @node Screen Size
12452 @section Screen size
12453 @cindex size of screen
12454 @cindex pauses in output
12455
12456 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12457 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12458 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12459 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12460 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12461 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12462 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12463 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12464
12465 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12466 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12467 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12468 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12469 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12470 width} commands:
12471
12472 @table @code
12473 @kindex set height
12474 @kindex set width
12475 @kindex show width
12476 @kindex show height
12477 @item set height @var{lpp}
12478 @itemx show height
12479 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12480 @itemx show width
12481 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12482 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12483 commands display the current settings.
12484
12485 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12486 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12487 file or to an editor buffer.
12488
12489 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12490 from wrapping its output.
12491 @end table
12492
12493 @node Numbers
12494 @section Numbers
12495 @cindex number representation
12496 @cindex entering numbers
12497
12498 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12499 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12500 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12501 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12502 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12503 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12504 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12505 radix} command.
12506
12507 @table @code
12508 @kindex set input-radix
12509 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12510 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12511 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12512 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12513 example, any of
12514
12515 @smallexample
12516 set radix 012
12517 set radix 10.
12518 set radix 0xa
12519 @end smallexample
12520
12521 @noindent
12522 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12523 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12524
12525 @kindex set output-radix
12526 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12527 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12528 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12529 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12530
12531 @kindex show input-radix
12532 @item show input-radix
12533 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12534
12535 @kindex show output-radix
12536 @item show output-radix
12537 Display the current default base for numeric display.
12538 @end table
12539
12540 @node Messages/Warnings
12541 @section Optional warnings and messages
12542
12543 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12544 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12545 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12546 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
12547
12548 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12549 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12550 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12551
12552 @table @code
12553 @kindex set verbose
12554 @item set verbose on
12555 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12556
12557 @item set verbose off
12558 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12559
12560 @kindex show verbose
12561 @item show verbose
12562 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12563 @end table
12564
12565 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12566 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12567 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12568 symbol files}).
12569
12570 @table @code
12571
12572 @kindex set complaints
12573 @item set complaints @var{limit}
12574 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12575 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12576 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12577 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
12578
12579 @kindex show complaints
12580 @item show complaints
12581 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
12582
12583 @end table
12584
12585 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12586 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12587 you try to run a program which is already running:
12588
12589 @smallexample
12590 (@value{GDBP}) run
12591 The program being debugged has been started already.
12592 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12593 @end smallexample
12594
12595 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12596 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12597
12598 @table @code
12599
12600 @kindex set confirm
12601 @cindex flinching
12602 @cindex confirmation
12603 @cindex stupid questions
12604 @item set confirm off
12605 Disables confirmation requests.
12606
12607 @item set confirm on
12608 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12609
12610 @kindex show confirm
12611 @item show confirm
12612 Displays state of confirmation requests.
12613
12614 @end table
12615
12616 @node Debugging Output
12617 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
12618 @table @code
12619 @kindex set debug arch
12620 @item set debug arch
12621 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12622 @kindex show debug arch
12623 @item show debug arch
12624 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12625 @kindex set debug event
12626 @item set debug event
12627 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12628 default is off.
12629 @kindex show debug event
12630 @item show debug event
12631 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12632 info.
12633 @kindex set debug expression
12634 @item set debug expression
12635 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12636 default is off.
12637 @kindex show debug expression
12638 @item show debug expression
12639 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12640 debugging info.
12641 @kindex set debug overload
12642 @item set debug overload
12643 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12644 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12645 is off.
12646 @kindex show debug overload
12647 @item show debug overload
12648 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12649 debugging info.
12650 @kindex set debug remote
12651 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12652 @cindex serial connections, debugging
12653 @item set debug remote
12654 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12655 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12656 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12657 @kindex show debug remote
12658 @item show debug remote
12659 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12660 @kindex set debug serial
12661 @item set debug serial
12662 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12663 default is off.
12664 @kindex show debug serial
12665 @item show debug serial
12666 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12667 info.
12668 @kindex set debug target
12669 @item set debug target
12670 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12671 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12672 default is off.
12673 @kindex show debug target
12674 @item show debug target
12675 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12676 info.
12677 @kindex set debug varobj
12678 @item set debug varobj
12679 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12680 info. The default is off.
12681 @kindex show debug varobj
12682 @item show debug varobj
12683 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12684 debugging info.
12685 @end table
12686
12687 @node Sequences
12688 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12689
12690 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12691 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12692 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12693 files.
12694
12695 @menu
12696 * Define:: User-defined commands
12697 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12698 * Command Files:: Command files
12699 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
12700 @end menu
12701
12702 @node Define
12703 @section User-defined commands
12704
12705 @cindex user-defined command
12706 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12707 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12708 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12709 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12710 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
12711
12712 @smallexample
12713 define adder
12714 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12715 @end smallexample
12716
12717 @noindent
12718 To execute the command use:
12719
12720 @smallexample
12721 adder 1 2 3
12722 @end smallexample
12723
12724 @noindent
12725 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12726 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12727 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12728 functions calls.
12729
12730 @table @code
12731
12732 @kindex define
12733 @item define @var{commandname}
12734 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12735 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12736
12737 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12738 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12739 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12740
12741 @kindex if
12742 @kindex else
12743 @item if
12744 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12745 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12746 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12747 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12748 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12749 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12750
12751 @kindex while
12752 @item while
12753 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12754 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12755 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12756 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12757 evaluates to true.
12758
12759 @kindex document
12760 @item document @var{commandname}
12761 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12762 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12763 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12764 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12765 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12766 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12767
12768 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12769 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12770 does not change the documentation.
12771
12772 @kindex help user-defined
12773 @item help user-defined
12774 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12775 (if any) for each.
12776
12777 @kindex show user
12778 @item show user
12779 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
12780 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12781 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12782 definitions for all user-defined commands.
12783
12784 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
12785 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
12786 @item show max-user-call-depth
12787 @item set max-user-call-depth
12788 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many levels deep a
12789 user-defined call chain can go. Default is 1024.
12790
12791 @end table
12792
12793 When user-defined commands are executed, the
12794 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12795 stops execution of the user-defined command.
12796
12797 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12798 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12799 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12800 messages when used in a user-defined command.
12801
12802 @node Hooks
12803 @section User-defined command hooks
12804 @cindex command hooks
12805 @cindex hooks, for commands
12806 @cindex hooks, pre-command
12807
12808 @kindex hook
12809 @kindex hook-
12810 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12811 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12812 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12813 before that command.
12814
12815 @cindex hooks, post-command
12816 @kindex hookpost
12817 @kindex hookpost-
12818 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12819 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12820 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12821 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12822 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12823
12824 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12825 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12826
12827 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12828 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12829
12830 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12831 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12832 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12833 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12834 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12835
12836 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12837 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12838 you could define:
12839
12840 @smallexample
12841 define hook-stop
12842 handle SIGALRM nopass
12843 end
12844
12845 define hook-run
12846 handle SIGALRM pass
12847 end
12848
12849 define hook-continue
12850 handle SIGLARM pass
12851 end
12852 @end smallexample
12853
12854 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12855 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12856 you could define:
12857
12858 @smallexample
12859 define hook-echo
12860 echo <<<---
12861 end
12862
12863 define hookpost-echo
12864 echo --->>>\n
12865 end
12866
12867 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12868 <<<---Hello World--->>>
12869 (@value{GDBP})
12870
12871 @end smallexample
12872
12873 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12874 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12875 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12876 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12877 @c or not?
12878 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12879 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12880 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12881
12882 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12883 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12884
12885 @node Command Files
12886 @section Command files
12887
12888 @cindex command files
12889 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12890 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12891 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12892 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12893
12894 @cindex init file
12895 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12896 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12897 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12898 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12899 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12900 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12901 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
12902
12903 @enumerate
12904 @item
12905 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12906 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12907 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12908
12909 @item
12910 Processes command line options and operands.
12911
12912 @item
12913 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12914
12915 @item
12916 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12917 @end enumerate
12918
12919 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12920 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12921 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12922 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
12923
12924 @cindex init file name
12925 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12926 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12927 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12928 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12929 environments with special init file names:
12930
12931 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12932 @itemize @bullet
12933 @item
12934 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
12935
12936 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12937 @item
12938 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
12939
12940 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12941 @item
12942 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12943 @end itemize
12944
12945 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12946 @code{source} command:
12947
12948 @table @code
12949 @kindex source
12950 @item source @var{filename}
12951 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12952 @end table
12953
12954 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12955 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12956 of the command file.
12957
12958 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12959 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12960 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12961 when called from command files.
12962
12963 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
12964 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
12965 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
12966 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
12967 the next command.
12968
12969 @smallexample
12970 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
12971 @end smallexample
12972
12973 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
12974 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
12975 would be directed to @file{log}.
12976
12977 @node Output
12978 @section Commands for controlled output
12979
12980 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12981 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12982 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12983 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12984 want.
12985
12986 @table @code
12987 @kindex echo
12988 @item echo @var{text}
12989 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12990 @c because it is not in ANSI.
12991 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12992 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12993 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12994 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12995 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12996 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12997 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12998 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12999 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13000
13001 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13002 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13003
13004 @smallexample
13005 echo This is some text\n\
13006 which is continued\n\
13007 onto several lines.\n
13008 @end smallexample
13009
13010 produces the same output as
13011
13012 @smallexample
13013 echo This is some text\n
13014 echo which is continued\n
13015 echo onto several lines.\n
13016 @end smallexample
13017
13018 @kindex output
13019 @item output @var{expression}
13020 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13021 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13022 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13023 on expressions.
13024
13025 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13026 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13027 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13028 formats}, for more information.
13029
13030 @kindex printf
13031 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13032 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13033 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13034 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13035 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13036 subroutine
13037 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13038 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13039 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13040 @c supported.
13041
13042 @smallexample
13043 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13044 @end smallexample
13045
13046 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13047
13048 @smallexample
13049 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13050 @end smallexample
13051
13052 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13053 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13054 letter.
13055 @end table
13056
13057 @node TUI
13058 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13059 @cindex TUI
13060
13061 @menu
13062 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13063 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13064 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13065 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13066 @end menu
13067
13068 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13069 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13070 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13071 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13072 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13073 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13074
13075 @node TUI Overview
13076 @section TUI overview
13077
13078 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13079 @value{GDBN} runs:
13080
13081 @itemize @bullet
13082 @item
13083 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13084 windows on the terminal.
13085
13086 @item
13087 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13088 the TUI.
13089 @end itemize
13090
13091 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13092 on the terminal:
13093
13094 @table @emph
13095 @item command
13096 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13097 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13098 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13099 window is always visible.
13100
13101 @item source
13102 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13103 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13104 The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
13105 active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
13106
13107 @item assembly
13108 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13109
13110 @item register
13111 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13112 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13113 changed are highlighted.
13114
13115 @end table
13116
13117 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13118 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13119 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13120 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13121 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13122 The following layouts are available:
13123
13124 @itemize @bullet
13125 @item
13126 source
13127
13128 @item
13129 assembly
13130
13131 @item
13132 source and assembly
13133
13134 @item
13135 source and registers
13136
13137 @item
13138 assembly and registers
13139
13140 @end itemize
13141
13142 @node TUI Keys
13143 @section TUI Key Bindings
13144 @cindex TUI key bindings
13145
13146 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13147 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13148 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13149 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
13150 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13151
13152 @table @kbd
13153 @kindex C-x C-a
13154 @item C-x C-a
13155 @kindex C-x a
13156 @itemx C-x a
13157 @kindex C-x A
13158 @itemx C-x A
13159 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13160 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13161 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13162 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13163 The screen is then refreshed.
13164
13165 @kindex C-x 1
13166 @item C-x 1
13167 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13168 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13169 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13170
13171 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13172
13173 @kindex C-x 2
13174 @item C-x 2
13175 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13176 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13177 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13178 previous layout and the new one.
13179
13180 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13181
13182 @end table
13183
13184 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13185
13186 @table @key
13187 @kindex PgUp
13188 @item PgUp
13189 Scroll the active window one page up.
13190
13191 @kindex PgDn
13192 @item PgDn
13193 Scroll the active window one page down.
13194
13195 @kindex Up
13196 @item Up
13197 Scroll the active window one line up.
13198
13199 @kindex Down
13200 @item Down
13201 Scroll the active window one line down.
13202
13203 @kindex Left
13204 @item Left
13205 Scroll the active window one column left.
13206
13207 @kindex Right
13208 @item Right
13209 Scroll the active window one column right.
13210
13211 @kindex C-L
13212 @item C-L
13213 Refresh the screen.
13214
13215 @end table
13216
13217 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13218 for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13219 necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13220 @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13221
13222 @node TUI Commands
13223 @section TUI specific commands
13224 @cindex TUI commands
13225
13226 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13227 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13228 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13229 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13230 in the TUI mode.
13231
13232 @table @code
13233 @item layout next
13234 @kindex layout next
13235 Display the next layout.
13236
13237 @item layout prev
13238 @kindex layout prev
13239 Display the previous layout.
13240
13241 @item layout src
13242 @kindex layout src
13243 Display the source window only.
13244
13245 @item layout asm
13246 @kindex layout asm
13247 Display the assembly window only.
13248
13249 @item layout split
13250 @kindex layout split
13251 Display the source and assembly window.
13252
13253 @item layout regs
13254 @kindex layout regs
13255 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13256
13257 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13258 @kindex focus
13259 Set the focus to the named window.
13260 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13261 can be affected to another window.
13262
13263 @item refresh
13264 @kindex refresh
13265 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13266
13267 @item update
13268 @kindex update
13269 Update the source window and the current execution point.
13270
13271 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13272 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13273 @kindex winheight
13274 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13275 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13276 decrease it.
13277
13278 @end table
13279
13280 @node TUI Configuration
13281 @section TUI configuration variables
13282 @cindex TUI configuration variables
13283
13284 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13285 appearance of windows on the terminal.
13286
13287 @table @code
13288 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13289 @kindex set tui border-kind
13290 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13291 The possible values are the following:
13292 @table @code
13293 @item space
13294 Use a space character to draw the border.
13295
13296 @item ascii
13297 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13298
13299 @item acs
13300 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13301 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
13302
13303 @end table
13304
13305 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13306 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
13307 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13308 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13309 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
13310
13311 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13312 @kindex set tui border-mode
13313 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13314 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13315 @table @code
13316 @item normal
13317 Use normal attributes to display the border.
13318
13319 @item standout
13320 Use standout mode.
13321
13322 @item reverse
13323 Use reverse video mode.
13324
13325 @item half
13326 Use half bright mode.
13327
13328 @item half-standout
13329 Use half bright and standout mode.
13330
13331 @item bold
13332 Use extra bright or bold mode.
13333
13334 @item bold-standout
13335 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
13336
13337 @end table
13338
13339 @end table
13340
13341 @node Emacs
13342 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13343
13344 @cindex Emacs
13345 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13346 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13347 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13348 @value{GDBN}.
13349
13350 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13351 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13352 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13353 created Emacs buffer.
13354 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
13355
13356 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13357 things:
13358
13359 @itemize @bullet
13360 @item
13361 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13362 @end itemize
13363
13364 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13365 and output done by the program you are debugging.
13366
13367 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13368 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13369 in this way.
13370
13371 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13372 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13373 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13374 stop.
13375
13376 @itemize @bullet
13377 @item
13378 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13379 @end itemize
13380
13381 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13382 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13383 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13384 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13385 and the source.
13386
13387 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13388 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13389
13390 @quotation
13391 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13392 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13393 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13394 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13395 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13396 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13397 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13398 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13399 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13400 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13401
13402 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13403 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13404 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13405 @end quotation
13406
13407 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13408 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13409 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13410 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13411
13412 @smallexample
13413 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13414 @end smallexample
13415
13416 @noindent
13417 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13418 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13419 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13420
13421 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13422 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13423
13424 @table @kbd
13425 @item C-h m
13426 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13427
13428 @item M-s
13429 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13430 update the display window to show the current file and location.
13431
13432 @item M-n
13433 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13434 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13435 to show the current file and location.
13436
13437 @item M-i
13438 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13439 display window accordingly.
13440
13441 @item M-x gdb-nexti
13442 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13443 display window accordingly.
13444
13445 @item C-c C-f
13446 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13447 @code{finish} command.
13448
13449 @item M-c
13450 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13451 command.
13452
13453 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13454
13455 @item M-u
13456 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13457 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13458 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13459
13460 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13461
13462 @item M-d
13463 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13464 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13465
13466 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13467
13468 @item C-x &
13469 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13470 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13471 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13472 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13473 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13474
13475 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13476 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13477 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13478 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13479 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13480 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13481 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13482 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13483 @end table
13484
13485 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13486 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13487
13488 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13489 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13490 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13491 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13492 frame.
13493
13494 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13495 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13496 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13497 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13498 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13499 to correspond properly with the code.
13500
13501 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13502 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13503 @ignore
13504 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13505 @kindex Epoch
13506 @kindex inspect
13507
13508 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13509 called the @code{epoch}
13510 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13511 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13512 each value is printed in its own window.
13513 @end ignore
13514
13515 @include annotate.texi
13516 @include gdbmi.texinfo
13517
13518 @node GDB Bugs
13519 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13520 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13521 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13522
13523 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13524
13525 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13526 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13527 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13528 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13529
13530 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13531 information that enables us to fix the bug.
13532
13533 @menu
13534 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13535 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13536 @end menu
13537
13538 @node Bug Criteria
13539 @section Have you found a bug?
13540 @cindex bug criteria
13541
13542 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13543
13544 @itemize @bullet
13545 @cindex fatal signal
13546 @cindex debugger crash
13547 @cindex crash of debugger
13548 @item
13549 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13550 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13551
13552 @cindex error on valid input
13553 @item
13554 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13555 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13556 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13557
13558 @cindex invalid input
13559 @item
13560 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13561 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13562 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13563 for traditional practice''.
13564
13565 @item
13566 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13567 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13568 @end itemize
13569
13570 @node Bug Reporting
13571 @section How to report bugs
13572 @cindex bug reports
13573 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13574
13575 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13576 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13577 contact that organization first.
13578
13579 You can find contact information for many support companies and
13580 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13581 distribution.
13582 @c should add a web page ref...
13583
13584 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
13585 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
13586 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
13587 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
13588 be used.
13589
13590 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13591 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13592 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13593 @samp{bug-gdb}.
13594
13595 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13596 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13597 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13598 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13599 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13600 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13601 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13602 bug reports to the mailing list.
13603
13604 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13605 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13606 fact or leave it out, state it!
13607
13608 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13609 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13610 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13611 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13612 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13613 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13614 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13615 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13616 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13617
13618 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13619 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13620 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13621 self-contained.
13622
13623 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13624 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13625 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13626 bugs properly.
13627
13628 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13629
13630 @itemize @bullet
13631 @item
13632 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13633 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13634 version}.
13635
13636 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13637 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13638
13639 @item
13640 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13641 version number.
13642
13643 @item
13644 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13645 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
13646
13647 @item
13648 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13649 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13650 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13651 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13652 compilers.
13653
13654 @item
13655 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13656 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13657 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13658 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13659
13660 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13661 and then we might not encounter the bug.
13662
13663 @item
13664 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13665 reproduce the bug.
13666
13667 @item
13668 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13669 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13670
13671 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13672 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13673 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13674 a chance to make a mistake.
13675
13676 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13677 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13678 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13679 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13680 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13681 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13682 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13683 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13684
13685 @item
13686 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13687 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13688 it by context, not by line number.
13689
13690 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13691 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
13692
13693 @end itemize
13694
13695 Here are some things that are not necessary:
13696
13697 @itemize @bullet
13698 @item
13699 A description of the envelope of the bug.
13700
13701 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13702 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13703 changes will not affect it.
13704
13705 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13706 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13707 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13708 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13709
13710 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13711 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13712 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13713 less time, and so on.
13714
13715 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13716 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13717
13718 @item
13719 A patch for the bug.
13720
13721 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13722 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13723 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13724 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13725
13726 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13727 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13728 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13729 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13730
13731 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13732 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13733 help us to understand.
13734
13735 @item
13736 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13737
13738 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13739 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13740 @end itemize
13741
13742 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13743 @c and consists of the two following files:
13744 @c rluser.texinfo
13745 @c inc-hist.texinfo
13746 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13747 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13748 @include rluser.texinfo
13749 @include inc-hist.texinfo
13750
13751
13752 @node Formatting Documentation
13753 @appendix Formatting Documentation
13754
13755 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13756 @cindex reference card
13757 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13758 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13759 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13760 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13761 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13762 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13763
13764 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13765 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13766
13767 @smallexample
13768 make refcard.dvi
13769 @end smallexample
13770
13771 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13772 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13773 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13774 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13775 your @sc{dvi} output program.
13776
13777 @cindex documentation
13778
13779 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13780 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13781 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13782 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13783 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13784 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13785
13786 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13787 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13788 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13789 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13790 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13791 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13792 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13793 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13794
13795 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13796 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13797 @code{makeinfo}.
13798
13799 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13800 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13801 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13802
13803 @smallexample
13804 cd gdb
13805 make gdb.info
13806 @end smallexample
13807
13808 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13809 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13810 Texinfo definitions file.
13811
13812 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13813 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13814 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13815 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13816 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13817 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13818 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13819
13820 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13821 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13822 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13823 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13824 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13825 directory.
13826
13827 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13828 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13829 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13830 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13831
13832 @smallexample
13833 make gdb.dvi
13834 @end smallexample
13835
13836 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
13837
13838 @node Installing GDB
13839 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13840 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13841 @cindex installation
13842
13843 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13844 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13845 build the @code{gdb} program.
13846 @iftex
13847 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13848 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13849 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13850 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13851 @end iftex
13852
13853 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13854 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13855 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13856
13857 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13858 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13859
13860 @table @code
13861 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13862 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13863
13864 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13865 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13866
13867 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13868 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13869
13870 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13871 @sc{gnu} include files
13872
13873 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13874 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13875
13876 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13877 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13878
13879 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13880 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13881
13882 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13883 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13884
13885 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13886 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13887 @end table
13888
13889 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13890 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13891 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13892
13893 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13894 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13895 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13896 argument.
13897
13898 For example:
13899
13900 @smallexample
13901 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13902 ./configure @var{host}
13903 make
13904 @end smallexample
13905
13906 @noindent
13907 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13908 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13909 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13910 correct value by examining your system.)
13911
13912 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13913 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13914 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13915 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13916
13917 @need 750
13918 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13919 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13920 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13921
13922 @smallexample
13923 sh configure @var{host}
13924 @end smallexample
13925
13926 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13927 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13928 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13929 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13930 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13931
13932 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13933 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13934 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13935
13936 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13937 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13938
13939 @smallexample
13940 @group
13941 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13942 ../configure @var{host}
13943 @end group
13944 @end smallexample
13945
13946 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13947 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13948 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13949 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13950 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13951
13952 @menu
13953 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13954 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13955 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13956 @end menu
13957
13958 @node Separate Objdir
13959 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13960
13961 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13962 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13963 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13964 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13965 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13966 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13967 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13968 program specified there.
13969
13970 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13971 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13972 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13973 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13974 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13975 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13976
13977 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
13978 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13979
13980 @smallexample
13981 @group
13982 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13983 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13984 cd ../gdb-sun4
13985 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13986 make
13987 @end group
13988 @end smallexample
13989
13990 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13991 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13992 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13993 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13994 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13995 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13996
13997 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
13998 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13999 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14000 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14001 You specify a cross-debugging target by
14002 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
14003
14004 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14005 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14006 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
14007
14008 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14009 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14010 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14011 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14012 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
14013
14014 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14015 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14016 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14017 with each other.
14018
14019 @node Config Names
14020 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
14021
14022 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14023 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14024 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14025 of information in the following pattern:
14026
14027 @smallexample
14028 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
14029 @end smallexample
14030
14031 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14032 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14033 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
14034
14035 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14036 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14037 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14038 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14039 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14040 abbreviations---for example:
14041
14042 @smallexample
14043 % sh config.sub i386-linux
14044 i386-pc-linux-gnu
14045 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
14046 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14047 % sh config.sub hp9k700
14048 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14049 % sh config.sub sun4
14050 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14051 % sh config.sub sun3
14052 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14053 % sh config.sub i986v
14054 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14055 @end smallexample
14056
14057 @noindent
14058 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14059 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
14060
14061 @node Configure Options
14062 @section @code{configure} options
14063
14064 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14065 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14066 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14067 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
14068
14069 @smallexample
14070 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14071 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14072 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14073 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14074 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14075 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14076 @var{host}
14077 @end smallexample
14078
14079 @noindent
14080 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14081 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14082 @samp{--}.
14083
14084 @table @code
14085 @item --help
14086 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
14087
14088 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
14089 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14090 @file{@var{dir}}.
14091
14092 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14093 Configure the source to install programs under directory
14094 @file{@var{dir}}.
14095
14096 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14097 @need 2000
14098 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14099 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14100 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14101 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14102 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14103 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14104 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14105 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14106 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14107 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14108 @var{dirname}.
14109
14110 @item --norecursion
14111 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14112 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
14113
14114 @item --target=@var{target}
14115 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14116 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14117 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
14118
14119 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
14120
14121 @item @var{host} @dots{}
14122 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
14123
14124 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14125 @end table
14126
14127 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14128 needed for special purposes only.
14129
14130 @node Maintenance Commands
14131 @appendix Maintenance Commands
14132 @cindex maintenance commands
14133 @cindex internal commands
14134
14135 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14136 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14137 These commands are provided here for reference.
14138
14139 @table @code
14140 @kindex maint info breakpoints
14141 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14142 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14143 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14144 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14145 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14146 is shown:
14147
14148 @table @code
14149 @item breakpoint
14150 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
14151
14152 @item watchpoint
14153 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
14154
14155 @item longjmp
14156 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14157 @code{longjmp} calls.
14158
14159 @item longjmp resume
14160 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
14161
14162 @item until
14163 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
14164
14165 @item finish
14166 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
14167
14168 @item shlib events
14169 Shared library events.
14170
14171 @end table
14172
14173 @end table
14174
14175
14176 @node Remote Protocol
14177 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
14178
14179 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14180 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14181 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14182 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
14183
14184 In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
14185 transmitted and received data respectfully.
14186
14187 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14188 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14189 @cindex remote serial protocol
14190 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14191 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14192 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14193 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
14194
14195 @smallexample
14196 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14197 @end smallexample
14198 @noindent
14199
14200 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14201 @noindent
14202 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14203 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14204 eight bit unsigned checksum).
14205
14206 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14207 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
14208
14209 @smallexample
14210 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14211 @end smallexample
14212
14213 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14214 @noindent
14215 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14216 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14217 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
14218
14219 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14220 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14221 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14222 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14223 retransmission):
14224
14225 @smallexample
14226 <- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14227 -> @code{+}
14228 @end smallexample
14229 @noindent
14230
14231 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14232 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14233 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14234 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
14235
14236 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14237 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14238 exceptions).
14239
14240 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14241 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14242 HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
14243
14244 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14245 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14246 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
14247
14248 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14249 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14250 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14251 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14252 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14253 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14254 value greater than 126 should not be used.
14255
14256 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14257 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14258 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
14259
14260 So:
14261 @smallexample
14262 "@code{0* }"
14263 @end smallexample
14264 @noindent
14265 means the same as "0000".
14266
14267 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14268 error number. That number is not well defined.
14269
14270 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14271 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14272 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14273 on that response.
14274
14275 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14276 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14277 optional.
14278
14279 Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
14280 their corresponding response @var{data}:
14281 @page
14282 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
14283 @item Packet
14284 @tab Request
14285 @tab Description
14286
14287 @item extended mode
14288 @tab @code{!}
14289 @tab
14290 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14291 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14292 debugged.
14293 @item
14294 @tab reply @samp{OK}
14295 @tab
14296 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
14297
14298 @item last signal
14299 @tab @code{?}
14300 @tab
14301 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
14302 and continue.
14303 @item
14304 @tab reply
14305 @tab see below
14306
14307
14308 @item reserved
14309 @tab @code{a}
14310 @tab Reserved for future use
14311
14312 @item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14313 @tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
14314 @tab
14315 @item
14316 @tab
14317 @tab
14318 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14319 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14320 See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
14321 @item
14322 @tab reply @code{OK}
14323 @item
14324 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14325
14326 @item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14327 @tab @code{b}@var{baud}
14328 @tab
14329 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
14330 transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
14331 transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
14332 acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
14333 to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
14334 ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
14335 specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
14336 that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
14337 happened.}
14338
14339 @item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14340 @tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
14341 @tab
14342 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14343 breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
14344 @samp{z} packets.}
14345
14346 @item continue
14347 @tab @code{c}@var{addr}
14348 @tab
14349 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14350 current address.
14351 @item
14352 @tab reply
14353 @tab see below
14354
14355 @item continue with signal
14356 @tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14357 @tab
14358 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14359 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14360 @item
14361 @tab reply
14362 @tab see below
14363
14364 @item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14365 @tab @code{d}
14366 @tab
14367 toggle debug flag.
14368
14369 @item detach
14370 @tab @code{D}
14371 @tab
14372 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
14373 @value{GDBN} disconnects.
14374 @item
14375 @tab reply @emph{no response}
14376 @tab
14377 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
14378
14379 @item reserved
14380 @tab @code{e}
14381 @tab Reserved for future use
14382
14383 @item reserved
14384 @tab @code{E}
14385 @tab Reserved for future use
14386
14387 @item reserved
14388 @tab @code{f}
14389 @tab Reserved for future use
14390
14391 @item reserved
14392 @tab @code{F}
14393 @tab Reserved for future use
14394
14395 @item read registers
14396 @tab @code{g}
14397 @tab Read general registers.
14398 @item
14399 @tab reply @var{XX...}
14400 @tab
14401 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14402 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14403 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
14404 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
14405 @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
14406 @code{g} packets is specified below.
14407 @item
14408 @tab @code{E}@var{NN}
14409 @tab for an error.
14410
14411 @item write regs
14412 @tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
14413 @tab
14414 See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
14415 @item
14416 @tab reply @code{OK}
14417 @tab for success
14418 @item
14419 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14420 @tab for an error
14421
14422 @item reserved
14423 @tab @code{h}
14424 @tab Reserved for future use
14425
14426 @item set thread
14427 @tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
14428 @tab
14429 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
14430 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
14431 continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
14432 thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
14433 @item
14434 @tab reply @code{OK}
14435 @tab for success
14436 @item
14437 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14438 @tab for an error
14439
14440 @c FIXME: JTC:
14441 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14442 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14443 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14444 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14445 @c described. For example:
14446 @c
14447 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14448 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14449 @c otherwise returns current registers.
14450 @c
14451 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14452 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14453 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
14454
14455 @item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14456 @tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
14457 @tab
14458 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14459 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14460 step starting at that address.
14461
14462 @item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14463 @tab @code{I}
14464 @tab
14465 See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
14466
14467 @item reserved
14468 @tab @code{j}
14469 @tab Reserved for future use
14470
14471 @item reserved
14472 @tab @code{J}
14473 @tab Reserved for future use
14474
14475 @item kill request
14476 @tab @code{k}
14477 @tab
14478 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
14479 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
14480
14481 @item reserved
14482 @tab @code{l}
14483 @tab Reserved for future use
14484
14485 @item reserved
14486 @tab @code{L}
14487 @tab Reserved for future use
14488
14489 @item read memory
14490 @tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14491 @tab
14492 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14493 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
14494 using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
14495 transfer mechanism is needed.}
14496 @item
14497 @tab reply @var{XX...}
14498 @tab
14499 @var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14500 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
14501 sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
14502 @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
14503 @item
14504 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14505 @tab @var{NN} is errno
14506
14507 @item write mem
14508 @tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
14509 @tab
14510 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14511 @var{XX...} is the data.
14512 @item
14513 @tab reply @code{OK}
14514 @tab for success
14515 @item
14516 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14517 @tab
14518 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14519 written).
14520
14521 @item reserved
14522 @tab @code{n}
14523 @tab Reserved for future use
14524
14525 @item reserved
14526 @tab @code{N}
14527 @tab Reserved for future use
14528
14529 @item reserved
14530 @tab @code{o}
14531 @tab Reserved for future use
14532
14533 @item reserved
14534 @tab @code{O}
14535 @tab Reserved for future use
14536
14537 @item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14538 @tab @code{p}@var{n...}
14539 @tab
14540 See write register.
14541 @item
14542 @tab return @var{r....}
14543 @tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
14544
14545 @item write reg
14546 @tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
14547 @tab
14548 Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
14549 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
14550 @item
14551 @tab reply @code{OK}
14552 @tab for success
14553 @item
14554 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14555 @tab for an error
14556
14557 @item general query
14558 @tab @code{q}@var{query}
14559 @tab
14560 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
14561 have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
14562 company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
14563 optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
14564 must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
14565 @item
14566 @tab reply @code{XX...}
14567 @tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14568 @item
14569 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14570 @tab error reply
14571 @item
14572 @tab reply @samp{}
14573 @tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
14574
14575 @item general set
14576 @tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
14577 @tab
14578 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
14579 naming conventions.
14580
14581 @item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14582 @tab @code{r}
14583 @tab
14584 Reset the entire system.
14585
14586 @item remote restart
14587 @tab @code{R}@var{XX}
14588 @tab
14589 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14590 This packet is only available in extended mode.
14591 @item
14592 @tab
14593 no reply
14594 @tab
14595 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
14596
14597 @item step
14598 @tab @code{s}@var{addr}
14599 @tab
14600 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14601 same address.
14602 @item
14603 @tab reply
14604 @tab see below
14605
14606 @item step with signal
14607 @tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14608 @tab
14609 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
14610 @item
14611 @tab reply
14612 @tab see below
14613
14614 @item search
14615 @tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
14616 @tab
14617 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
14618 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
14619 bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
14620
14621 @item thread alive
14622 @tab @code{T}@var{XX}
14623 @tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
14624 @item
14625 @tab reply @code{OK}
14626 @tab thread is still alive
14627 @item
14628 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14629 @tab thread is dead
14630
14631 @item reserved
14632 @tab @code{u}
14633 @tab Reserved for future use
14634
14635 @item reserved
14636 @tab @code{U}
14637 @tab Reserved for future use
14638
14639 @item reserved
14640 @tab @code{v}
14641 @tab Reserved for future use
14642
14643 @item reserved
14644 @tab @code{V}
14645 @tab Reserved for future use
14646
14647 @item reserved
14648 @tab @code{w}
14649 @tab Reserved for future use
14650
14651 @item reserved
14652 @tab @code{W}
14653 @tab Reserved for future use
14654
14655 @item reserved
14656 @tab @code{x}
14657 @tab Reserved for future use
14658
14659 @item write mem (binary)
14660 @tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
14661 @tab
14662 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
14663 binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
14664 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
14665 @item
14666 @tab reply @code{OK}
14667 @tab for success
14668 @item
14669 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14670 @tab for an error
14671
14672 @item reserved
14673 @tab @code{y}
14674 @tab Reserved for future use
14675
14676 @item reserved
14677 @tab @code{Y}
14678 @tab Reserved for future use
14679
14680 @item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14681 @tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14682 @tab
14683 See @samp{Z}.
14684
14685 @item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14686 @tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14687 @tab
14688 @var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
14689 breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
14690 @samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
14691 bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
14692 the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14693 @var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
14694 potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
14695 implemented in an idempotent way.
14696 @item
14697 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14698 @tab for an error
14699 @item
14700 @tab reply @code{OK}
14701 @tab for success
14702 @item
14703 @tab @samp{}
14704 @tab If not supported.
14705
14706 @item reserved
14707 @tab <other>
14708 @tab Reserved for future use
14709
14710 @end multitable
14711
14712 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
14713 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
14714 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
14715 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
14716 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
14717 conventions is used.
14718
14719 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
14720
14721 @item @code{S}@var{AA}
14722 @tab @var{AA} is the signal number
14723
14724 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
14725 @tab
14726 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
14727 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
14728 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
14729 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
14730 starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
14731 @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
14732 extend the protocol.
14733
14734 @item @code{W}@var{AA}
14735 @tab
14736 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
14737 applicable for certains sorts of targets.
14738
14739 @item @code{X}@var{AA}
14740 @tab
14741 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
14742
14743 @item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
14744 @tab
14745 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
14746 @var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
14747 @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
14748 this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
14749 spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
14750 debugger.}
14751
14752 @item @code{O}@var{XX...}
14753 @tab
14754 @var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
14755 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
14756 for 'W', 'T', etc.
14757
14758 @end multitable
14759
14760 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
14761
14762 @multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
14763
14764 @item current thread
14765 @tab @code{q}@code{C}
14766 @tab Return the current thread id.
14767 @item
14768 @tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
14769 @tab
14770 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
14771 @item
14772 @tab reply *
14773 @tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
14774
14775 @item all thread ids
14776 @tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14777 @item
14778 @tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
14779 @tab
14780 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
14781 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
14782 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
14783 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
14784 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
14785 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
14786 @item
14787 @tab
14788 @tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
14789 @item
14790 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
14791 @tab A single thread id
14792 @item
14793 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
14794 @tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
14795 @item
14796 @tab reply @code{l}
14797 @tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
14798 @item
14799 @tab
14800 @tab
14801 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
14802 or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
14803 respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
14804 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
14805 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
14806
14807 @item extra thread info
14808 @tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
14809 @tab
14810 @item
14811 @tab
14812 @tab
14813 Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
14814 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
14815 the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
14816 thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
14817 The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
14818 Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
14819 "Blocked on Mutex".
14820 @item
14821 @tab reply @var{XX...}
14822 @tab
14823 Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
14824 printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
14825 attributes.
14826
14827 @item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
14828 @tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
14829 @tab
14830 @item
14831 @tab
14832 @tab
14833 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
14834 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
14835 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
14836 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
14837 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
14838 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
14839 @item
14840 @tab
14841 @tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14842 query (see above).
14843 @item
14844 @tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
14845 @tab
14846 @item
14847 @tab
14848 @tab
14849 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
14850 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
14851 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
14852 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
14853 a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
14854 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
14855
14856 @item compute CRC of memory block
14857 @tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14858 @tab
14859 @item
14860 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14861 @tab An error (such as memory fault)
14862 @item
14863 @tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
14864 @tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
14865
14866 @item query sect offs
14867 @tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
14868 @tab
14869 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
14870 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
14871 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
14872 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
14873 @item
14874 @tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
14875
14876 @item thread info request
14877 @tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
14878 @tab
14879 @item
14880 @tab
14881 @tab
14882 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
14883 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
14884 @item
14885 @tab reply *
14886 @tab
14887 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
14888
14889 @item remote command
14890 @tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
14891 @tab
14892 @item
14893 @tab
14894 @tab
14895 @var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
14896 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
14897 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
14898 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
14899 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
14900 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
14901 @item
14902 @tab reply @code{OK}
14903 @tab
14904 A command response with no output.
14905 @item
14906 @tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
14907 @tab
14908 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
14909 @item
14910 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14911 @tab
14912 Indicate a badly formed request.
14913
14914 @item
14915 @tab reply @samp{}
14916 @tab
14917 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
14918
14919 @item symbol lookup
14920 @tab @code{qSymbol::}
14921 @tab
14922 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
14923 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
14924 @item
14925 @tab
14926 @tab
14927 @item
14928 @tab reply @code{OK}
14929 @tab
14930 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14931 @item
14932 @tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14933 @tab
14934 @sp 2
14935 @noindent
14936 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14937 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
14938 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14939 message, described below.
14940
14941 @item symbol value
14942 @tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14943 @tab
14944 @sp 1
14945 @noindent
14946 Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
14947 @item
14948 @tab
14949 @tab
14950 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
14951 the target has previously requested.
14952 @item
14953 @tab
14954 @tab
14955 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
14956 If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
14957 field will be empty.
14958 @item
14959 @tab reply @code{OK}
14960 @tab
14961 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14962 @item
14963 @tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14964 @tab
14965 @sp 2
14966 @noindent
14967 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14968 @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
14969 until the target ceases to request them.
14970
14971 @end multitable
14972
14973 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
14974 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
14975 bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
14976 space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
14977 The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
14978 least-significant.
14979
14980 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
14981
14982 @item MIPS32
14983 @tab
14984 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
14985 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
14986 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
14987
14988 @item MIPS64
14989 @tab
14990 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
14991 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
14992 as @code{MIPS32}.
14993
14994 @end multitable
14995
14996 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
14997 does not get any direct output:
14998
14999 @smallexample
15000 <- @code{R00}
15001 -> @code{+}
15002 @emph{target restarts}
15003 <- @code{?}
15004 -> @code{+}
15005 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15006 <- @code{+}
15007 @end smallexample
15008
15009 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
15010
15011 @smallexample
15012 <- @code{G1445...}
15013 -> @code{+}
15014 <- @code{s}
15015 -> @code{+}
15016 @emph{time passes}
15017 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15018 <- @code{+}
15019 <- @code{g}
15020 -> @code{+}
15021 -> @code{1455...}
15022 <- @code{+}
15023 @end smallexample
15024
15025 @include gpl.texi
15026
15027 @include fdl.texi
15028
15029 @node Index
15030 @unnumbered Index
15031
15032 @printindex cp
15033
15034 @tex
15035 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15036 % meantime:
15037 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15038 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15039 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15040 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15041 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15042 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15043 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15044 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15045 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15046 \page\colophon
15047 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15048 @end tex
15049
15050 @bye
This page took 0.31908 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.